xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-4.7/gcc/doc/tm.texi.in (revision f503b4c4)
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints::     The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs::             Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses::  Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC::                 Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point::      Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS::        Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors::   MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target::          Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI::             Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc::                Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''.  This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''.  This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself.  It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands.  It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones.  It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options.  It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver.  It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default.  This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target.  The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified.  The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper).  This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments.  If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}.  On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead.  @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.  If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
393removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394@end defmac
395
396@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397
398@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
399Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
400string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
401target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
402@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
403
404Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
405the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
407@xref{Target Fragment}.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
411Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
412a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
413indicates an absolute file name.
414@end defmac
415
416@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
417If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
418@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
419when the compiler is built as a cross
420compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
421to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
425Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
427try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
428@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
429is built as a cross compiler.
430@end defmac
431
432@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
433Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
435when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
437is built as a cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
443default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
445is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
449If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
451compiler is built as a cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
455If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
456standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
457cross compiler.
458@end defmac
459
460@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
462variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
463loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
464initialize the necessary environment variables.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
471comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
472@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
473
474Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
475replacement.
476@end defmac
477
478@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
479The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
480See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
481If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
482@end defmac
483
484@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
485Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
486for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
487usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
488@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
489@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
490and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
491and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
492@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
493
494The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
495Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
496string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
497for C++-only directories,
498and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
499wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
500the array with a null element.
501
502The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
503if any, in all uppercase letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
504or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
505operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
506
507For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
508
509@smallexample
510#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
511@{                                       \
512  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
513  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
514  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
515  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
516  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
517@}
518@end smallexample
519@end defmac
520
521Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
522
523@enumerate
524@item
525Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
526
527@item
528The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
529is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
530@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
531
532@item
533The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
534
535@item
536The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
537in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
538
539@item
540The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
541
542@item
543The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
544
545@item
546The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
547compiler.
548@end enumerate
549
550Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
551
552@enumerate
553@item
554Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556@item
557The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
558value based on the installed toolchain location.
559
560@item
561The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
562(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
563
564@item
565The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
566in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
567
568@item
569The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
570
571@item
572The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
573compiler.
574
575@item
576The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
577native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579@item
580The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
581native compiler, or we have a target system root.
582
583@item
584The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
585If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
586the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
587
588@item
589The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
590compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
591@file{/lib/}.
592
593@item
594The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
595compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
596@file{/usr/lib/}.
597@end enumerate
598
599@node Run-time Target
600@section Run-time Target Specification
601@cindex run-time target specification
602@cindex predefined macros
603@cindex target specifications
604
605@c prevent bad page break with this line
606Here are run-time target specifications.
607
608@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
609This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
610built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
611the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
612@code{builtin_assert}.  When the front end
613calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
614finished command line option processing your code can use those
615results freely.
616
617@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
618command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
619the assertion.  @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
620accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
621
622@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
623object-like macro.  If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
624@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally.  Otherwise, it
625defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
626with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
627only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line.  For
628example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
629and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
630@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
631defines only @code{_ABI64}.
632
633You can also test for the C dialect being compiled.  The variable
634@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
635or @code{clk_objective_c}.  Note that if we are preprocessing
636assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
637macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
638to check for that first.  If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
639variable @code{flag_iso} can be used.  The function-like macro
640@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
641preprocessing.
642@end defmac
643
644@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
645Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
646and is used for the target operating system instead.
647@end defmac
648
649@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
650Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
651and is used for the target object format.  @file{elfos.h} uses this
652macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
653it yourself.
654@end defmac
655
656@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
657This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
658any target-specific headers.
659@end deftypevar
660
661@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
662This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
663Its default setting is 0.
664@end deftypevr
665
666@cindex optional hardware or system features
667@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
668
669@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
670This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
671target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
672(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
673processing and should return true if the option is valid.  The default
674definition does nothing but return true.
675
676@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments.  @var{opts} and
677@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
678storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
679option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
680via attributes).
681@end deftypefn
682
683@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
684This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
685target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
686definition files(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some
687option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
688valid.  The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}.  The
689default definition does nothing but return false.
690
691In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
692options.  However, if processing an option requires routines that are
693only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
694should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
695@end deftypefn
696
697@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
698
699@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
700
701@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
702
703@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
704This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
705but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
706pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
707attribute or pragma.  It is not called at the beginning of compilation
708when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
709actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
710@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
711@end deftypefn
712
713@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
714This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
715but is only used in the C
716language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
717used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
718frontends.
719@end defmac
720
721@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
722Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
723various optimization levels.   This variable, if defined, describes
724options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels.  These
725options are processed once
726just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
727of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
728options passed explicitly.
729
730This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
731options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
732@code{optimize} attribute.
733@end deftypevr
734
735@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
736
737@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
738
739@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
740Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
741during compilation.  For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
742the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16.  Source code
743can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
744and @code{nomips16} attributes.
745
746Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
747registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
748operations, and so on.  GCC caches a lot of this type of information
749in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
750significant amount of time.  The compiler therefore provides a facility
751for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
752switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
753
754Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility.  The default
755is 0.
756@end defmac
757
758@node Per-Function Data
759@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
760@cindex per-function data
761@cindex data structures
762
763If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
764provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
765using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
766nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
767when another one comes along.
768
769GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
770contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
771structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
772@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
773to their own specific data.
774
775If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
776@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
777This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
778@code{init_machine_status}.  This pointer is explained below.
779
780One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
781RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
782RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
783function, for level 0.
784
785Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
786all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
787function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
788stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
789stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
790@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
791the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
792single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
793longer supported.
794
795@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
796Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
797is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
798The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
799function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
800@end defmac
801
802@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
803If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
804function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
805target to perform any target specific initialization of the
806@code{struct function} structure.  It is intended that this would be
807used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
808
809@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
810Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
811GC allocation, including the structure itself.
812@end deftypevar
813
814@node Storage Layout
815@section Storage Layout
816@cindex storage layout
817
818Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
819alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
820expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
821@xref{Run-time Target}.
822
823@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
824Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
825byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
826This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
827bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
828be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
829macro need not be a constant.
830
831This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
832bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
833@end defmac
834
835@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
836Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
837word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
838@end defmac
839
840@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
841Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
842most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
843memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
844order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers.  This
845macro need not be a constant.
846@end defmac
847
848@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
849On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
850registers in memory.  In such a situation, define this macro to describe
851the order of words in a register.  The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
852the order of words in memory.
853@end defmac
854
855@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
856Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
857@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
858containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
859have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
860
861You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
862multi-word integers.
863@end defmac
864
865@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
866Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
867unit (byte).  If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
868@end defmac
869
870@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
871Number of bits in a word.  If you do not define this macro, the default
872is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
873@end defmac
874
875@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
876Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
877@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
878largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
879@end defmac
880
881@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
882Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
883register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
884@end defmac
885
886@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
887Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890@end defmac
891
892@defmac POINTER_SIZE
893Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
894width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
895you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.  If you do not specify
896a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
897@end defmac
898
899@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
900A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
901@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}.  It is
902greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
903should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
904is needed.  In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
905@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
906
907You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
908and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
909@end defmac
910
911@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
912A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
913is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
914stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
915scalar type.
916
917On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
918register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
919@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
920cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
921floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
922counterparts.
923
924For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
925However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
926either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
927the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
928sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
929@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
930
931Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
932@end defmac
933
934@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
935Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
936function return values.  The target hook should return the new mode
937and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
938change signedness.  This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
939pointer} types.
940
941@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
942return values.  If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
943@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
944If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
945which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
946then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
947the signedness may be different.
948
949@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
950
951The default is to not promote arguments and return values.  You can
952also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
953if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
954@end deftypefn
955
956@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
957Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
958bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
959regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
960size of an integer.
961@end defmac
962
963@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
964Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
965stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
966desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
967if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
968this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
969@end defmac
970
971@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
972Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
973stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
974is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
975macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
976@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
977@end defmac
978
979@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
980Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
981from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.  This macro must evaluate
982to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
983@end defmac
984
985@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
986Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
987@end defmac
988
989@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
990Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
991bits.  Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
992just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
993@end defmac
994
995@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
996Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
997provide.  If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1001Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct.  If
1002not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1006If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1007object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1008nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1009on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1010@end defmac
1011
1012@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1013Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1014machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1015structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1016by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1017@end defmac
1018
1019@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1020An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1021alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1022@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1023alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1024field alignment has not been set by the
1025@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1026@end defmac
1027
1028@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1029Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend.  Use this macro
1030to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1031
1032If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033
1034@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1035@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1036@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1037@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1038@end defmac
1039
1040@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1041Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1042Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1043@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1044the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1045
1046On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1047the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1048a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1049On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1050@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1051@end defmac
1052
1053@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1054If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1055the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1056the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1057macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1058
1059If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1060
1061@findex strcpy
1062One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1063make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1064arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1065constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1069If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1070that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1071@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1072have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1073align the object.
1074
1075If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1076
1077The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1078constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079constants can be done inline.
1080@end defmac
1081
1082@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1083If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1084the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1085the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1086macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1087
1088If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1089
1090One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1091make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1092
1093If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1094@end defmac
1095
1096@hook TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT
1097
1098@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1099If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1100@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1101and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1102have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1103align the slot.
1104
1105If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1106@var{type} is @code{NULL}.  Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1107be used.
1108
1109This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1110of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1111
1112If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1113@end defmac
1114
1115@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1116If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1117variable @var{decl}.
1118
1119If this macro is not defined, then
1120@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1121is used.
1122
1123One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1124make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1125
1126If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1127@end defmac
1128
1129@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1130If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1131for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1132@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1133
1134If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1135@end defmac
1136
1137@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1138Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1139empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1140
1141If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1142@end defmac
1143
1144@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1145Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1146Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1147
1148If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1149@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1150@end defmac
1151
1152@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1153Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1154if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1155go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1156@end defmac
1157
1158@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1159Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1160alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1161
1162The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1163@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1164structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1165that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1166that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1167
1168Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1169@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1170four-byte alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may
1171not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1172
1173An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1174structure.
1175
1176If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1177a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1178
1179Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1180bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1181support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1182@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1183
1184The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1185@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1186Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1187
1188Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1189@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1190@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1191
1192If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1193bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1194what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1195
1196@smallexample
1197struct foo1
1198@{
1199  char x;
1200  char :0;
1201  char y;
1202@};
1203
1204struct foo2
1205@{
1206  char x;
1207  int :0;
1208  char y;
1209@};
1210
1211main ()
1212@{
1213  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1214          sizeof (struct foo1));
1215  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1216          sizeof (struct foo2));
1217  exit (0);
1218@}
1219@end smallexample
1220
1221If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1222get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1223@end defmac
1224
1225@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1226Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1227to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1228@end defmac
1229
1230@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1231When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1232whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1233structure.  The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1234the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1235@end deftypefn
1236
1237@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1238This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1239should use the narrowest mode possible.  It should return @code{false} if
1240these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1241
1242The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1243@end deftypefn
1244
1245@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1246Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1247@code{BLKMODE}.
1248
1249If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1250mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode.  @var{mode} is provided in the
1251case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1252retain the field's mode.
1253
1254Normally, this is not needed.
1255@end defmac
1256
1257@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1258Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1259by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1260way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1261@var{specified}.
1262
1263The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1264the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1265@end defmac
1266
1267@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1268An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1269machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1270this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1271appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1272(DImode)} is assumed.
1273@end defmac
1274
1275@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1276If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1277specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1278@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1279@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1280@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1281having its mode specified.
1282
1283You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1284would most commonly define this macro if the
1285@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128664-bit mode.
1287@end defmac
1288
1289@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1290If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1291specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1292@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1293
1294You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1295You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1296pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1297@end defmac
1298
1299@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1300This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1301of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1302@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1303targets.
1304@end deftypefn
1305
1306@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1307This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1308of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1309@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1310targets.
1311@end deftypefn
1312
1313@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1314Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1315The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1316@end deftypefn
1317
1318@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1319If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1320mode is towards zero.
1321
1322Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1323floating-point arithmetic.
1324
1325Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1326@end defmac
1327
1328@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1329This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1330bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1331exponent for normal numbers instead.
1332
1333Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1334floating-point arithmetic.
1335
1336The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1337@end defmac
1338
1339@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1340This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1341@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1342Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1343unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1344different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1345alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1346bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1347the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1348(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1349another bit-field of nonzero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1350other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1351
1352When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1353of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1354bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1355and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1356chunk of 32 bits.  However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1357size is allocated).  In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1358alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1359
1360If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1361the latter will take precedence.  If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1362used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1363precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1364may affect its placement.
1365@end deftypefn
1366
1367@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1368Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1369@end deftypefn
1370
1371@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1372Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1373@end deftypefn
1374
1375@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1376This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1377to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1378For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1379for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1380registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1381usage.
1382@end deftypefn
1383
1384@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1385This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1386that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1387@end deftypefn
1388
1389@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1390If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1391uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1392to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1393mangled name.  The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1394the type to be mangled.  The hook may be applied to trees which are
1395not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1396for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize.  If the
1397return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1398string constant.
1399
1400Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1401qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types.  Encode new
1402fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1403is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1404length of @var{name} in decimal.  Encode qualified versions of
1405ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1406@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1407@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1408code used to represent the unqualified version of this type.  (See
1409@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1410codes.)  In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1411spaces in your string.
1412
1413This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution.  If the mangled
1414name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1415can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1416before mangling.
1417
1418The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1419appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1420types.
1421@end deftypefn
1422
1423@node Type Layout
1424@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1425
1426These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1427basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1428the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1429languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1430
1431@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1432A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1433target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1434@end defmac
1435
1436@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1437A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1438target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1439(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1440unit.)
1441@end defmac
1442
1443@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1444A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1445target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1446@end defmac
1447
1448@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1449On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1450@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@.  In
1451that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1452the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1453value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1454@end defmac
1455
1456@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1457A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1458target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1459words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1460macro must be at least 64.
1461@end defmac
1462
1463@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1464A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1465target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1466@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1467@end defmac
1468
1469@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1470A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1471C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1472this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1473@end defmac
1474
1475@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1476A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1477target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1478@end defmac
1479
1480@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1481A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1482target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1483words.
1484@end defmac
1485
1486@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1487A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1488the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1489words.
1490@end defmac
1491
1492@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1493A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1494the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1495@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1496@end defmac
1497
1498@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1499A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1500the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1501@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1502@end defmac
1503
1504@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1505A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1506the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1507@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1508@end defmac
1509
1510@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1511A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1512the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1513@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1514@end defmac
1515
1516@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1517A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1518the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1519@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1520@end defmac
1521
1522@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1523A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1524the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1525@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1526@end defmac
1527
1528@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1529A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1530the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1531@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1532@end defmac
1533
1534@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1535A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1536the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1537@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1538@end defmac
1539
1540@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1541Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1542if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1543@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  If you don't define this, the
1544default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1545@end defmac
1546
1547@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1548Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1549@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1550@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1551anyway.  If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1552or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1553otherwise it is 0.
1554@end defmac
1555
1556@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1557Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1558@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1559anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1560is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1561@end defmac
1562
1563@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1564Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1565@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1566anyway.  If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1567is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1568@end defmac
1569
1570@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1571This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1572hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true.  It
1573causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1574prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}.  A port which
1575uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1576the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1577@end defmac
1578
1579@defmac SF_SIZE
1580@defmacx DF_SIZE
1581@defmacx XF_SIZE
1582@defmacx TF_SIZE
1583Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1584@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1585if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate.  By default,
1586@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1587for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1588@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1589@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1590@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1591@end defmac
1592
1593@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1594A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1595assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1596default state.  If you do not define this macro the value of
1597@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1598@end defmac
1599
1600@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1601A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1602supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1603value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1604If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1605is the default.
1606@end defmac
1607
1608@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1609An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1610@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1611always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1612and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1613@end defmac
1614
1615@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1616This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1617@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1618of possible values of that type.  It should return false if all
1619@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1620
1621The default is to return false.
1622@end deftypefn
1623
1624@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1625A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1626for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1627contents of the string.
1628
1629The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1630spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1631appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1632of the data type names defined in the function
1633@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1634omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1635crash on startup.
1636
1637If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1638int"}.
1639@end defmac
1640
1641@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1642A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1643for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1644@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1645@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1646
1647If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1648@end defmac
1649
1650@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1651A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1652for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1653the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654information.
1655
1656If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1657@end defmac
1658
1659@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1660A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1661characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1662@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1663@end defmac
1664
1665@defmac WINT_TYPE
1666A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1667use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1668@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1669contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1670information.
1671
1672If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1673@end defmac
1674
1675@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1676A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1677can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1678The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1679string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1680
1681If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1682@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1683much precision as @code{long long int}.
1684@end defmac
1685
1686@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1687A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1688can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1689type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1690of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1691
1692If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1693@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1694unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1695int}.
1696@end defmac
1697
1698@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1701@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1702@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1705@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1706@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1709@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1710@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1714@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1717@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1718@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1721@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1723@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1724@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1725C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1726@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1727@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1728@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1729@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1730@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1731@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1732@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1733@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}.  See
1734@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1735
1736If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1737type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1738@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1739to C99, depending on the type in question.  The defaults for all of
1740these macros are null pointers.
1741@end defmac
1742
1743@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1744The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1745that looks like:
1746
1747@smallexample
1748  struct @{
1749    union @{
1750      void (*fn)();
1751      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1752    @};
1753    ptrdiff_t delta;
1754  @};
1755@end smallexample
1756
1757@noindent
1758The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1759will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1760Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1761always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1762distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1763platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1764that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1765the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1766
1767GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1768this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1769However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1770set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1771bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1772address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1773architecture, you should define this macro to
1774@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1775
1776In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1777in which function addresses are always even, according to
1778@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1779@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1780@end defmac
1781
1782@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1783Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1784macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1785instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1786function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1787data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1788pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1789
1790If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1791of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1792@end defmac
1793
1794@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1795By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1796is the same as pointer alignment.  The value of this macro specifies
1797the alignment of the vtable entry in bits.  It should be defined only
1798when special alignment is necessary. */
1799@end defmac
1800
1801@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1802There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1803zero.  If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1804specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1805of words in each data entry.
1806@end defmac
1807
1808@node Registers
1809@section Register Usage
1810@cindex register usage
1811
1812This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1813has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1814
1815The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1816done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1817on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1818For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1819For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1820
1821@menu
1822* Register Basics::             Number and kinds of registers.
1823* Allocation Order::            Order in which registers are allocated.
1824* Values in Registers::         What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1825* Leaf Functions::              Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1826* Stack Registers::             Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1827@end menu
1828
1829@node Register Basics
1830@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1831
1832@c prevent bad page break with this line
1833Registers have various characteristics.
1834
1835@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1836Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1837numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1838pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1839@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1840@end defmac
1841
1842@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1843@cindex fixed register
1844An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1845all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1846general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1847pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1848register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1849machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1850and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1851
1852This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1853commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1854register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1855
1856The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1857the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1858by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1859the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1860@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1861@end defmac
1862
1863@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1864@cindex call-used register
1865@cindex call-clobbered register
1866@cindex call-saved register
1867Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1868clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1869registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1870available for general allocation of values that must live across
1871function calls.
1872
1873If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1874automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1875exit, if the register is used within the function.
1876@end defmac
1877
1878@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1879@cindex call-used register
1880@cindex call-clobbered register
1881@cindex call-saved register
1882Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1883that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1884(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1885This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1886of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1887@end defmac
1888
1889@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1890@cindex call-used register
1891@cindex call-clobbered register
1892@cindex call-saved register
1893A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1894value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1895call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1896macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1897preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1898@end defmac
1899
1900@findex fixed_regs
1901@findex call_used_regs
1902@findex global_regs
1903@findex reg_names
1904@findex reg_class_contents
1905@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1906This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1907@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1908@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1909any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1910of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1911@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1912@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1913called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1914@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1915from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1916@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1917@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1918@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1919command options have been applied.
1920
1921@cindex disabling certain registers
1922@cindex controlling register usage
1923If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1924flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1925@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1926registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1927the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1928to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1929is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1930
1931(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1932of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1933controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1934these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1935@end deftypefn
1936
1937@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1938Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1939expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1940corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1941function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1942outbound register.
1943@end defmac
1944
1945@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1946Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1947expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1948corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1949function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1950register.
1951@end defmac
1952
1953@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1954Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1955expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1956register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1957need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1958gotos.
1959@end defmac
1960
1961@defmac PC_REGNUM
1962If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1963register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1964@end defmac
1965
1966@node Allocation Order
1967@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1968@cindex order of register allocation
1969@cindex register allocation order
1970
1971@c prevent bad page break with this line
1972Registers are allocated in order.
1973
1974@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1975If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1976numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1977to use them (from most preferred to least).
1978
1979If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1980(all else being equal).
1981
1982One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1983registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1984instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1985machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1986the highest numbered allocable register first.
1987@end defmac
1988
1989@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1990A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1991hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1992
1993Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1994Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1995register; and so on.
1996
1997The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1998@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1999
2000On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2001@end defmac
2002
2003@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2004Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2005prologue and restoring it in the epilogue.  This discourages it from
2006using call-saved registers.  If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2007allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2008call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2009should be defined.
2010@end defmac
2011
2012@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2013In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2014Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2015If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2016based on @var{regno}.  The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2017be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2018value returned by this macro.  Not defining this macro is equivalent
2019to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2020
2021On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2022@end defmac
2023
2024@node Values in Registers
2025@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2026
2027This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2028(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2029consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2030
2031@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2033at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2034@var{mode}.  This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2035cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2036and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2037
2038On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2039definition of this macro is
2040
2041@smallexample
2042#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
2043   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
2044    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2045@end smallexample
2046@end defmac
2047
2048@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2049A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2050in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2051in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2052multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2053this mode by the number of registers returned by
2054@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}).  By default this is zero.
2055
2056For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2057registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2058nonzero.
2059
2060This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2061@code{subreg_get_info}
2062would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2063represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2064@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2065registers and so not be representable.
2066@end defmac
2067
2068@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2069For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2070@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2071returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2072including any padding.  In the example above, the value would be four.
2073@end defmac
2074
2075@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2076Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2077of mode @var{mode} is not the word size.  It is a C expression that
2078should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode.  It is
2079used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results.  This
2080happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2081floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2082@end defmac
2083
2084@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2085A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2086of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2087registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
2088are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2089
2090@smallexample
2091#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2092@end smallexample
2093
2094You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2095because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2096
2097@cindex register pairs
2098On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2099register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2100odd register numbers for such modes.
2101
2102The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2103@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2104register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2105value into the register and back out not alter it.
2106
2107Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2108all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2109@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2110you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
2111is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2112and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2113to be tieable.
2114
2115Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2116Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2117in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
2118can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2119mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2120registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2121
2122On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2123modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
2124registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2125non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
2126@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2127floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
2128normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2129unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2130register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2131
2132The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2133they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2134instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
2135@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
2136constraints for those instructions.
2137
2138On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2139so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2140register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
2141floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2142be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2143@end defmac
2144
2145@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2146A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2147@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2148
2149One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2150another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2151handler.
2152
2153The default is always nonzero.
2154@end defmac
2155
2156@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2157A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2158@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2159
2160If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2161@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2162any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2163should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2164this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2165accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2166
2167You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2168possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2169allocation.
2170@end defmac
2171
2172@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2173This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2174@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2175
2176One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2177is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2178
2179The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2180@end deftypefn
2181
2182@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2183Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2184registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2185@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2186@end defmac
2187
2188@node Leaf Functions
2189@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2190
2191@cindex leaf functions
2192@cindex functions, leaf
2193On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2194more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
2195means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2196are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2197normally arrive.
2198
2199The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2200other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2201registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
2202function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2203handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2204functions''.
2205
2206GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2207suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
2208registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
2209accomplish this.
2210
2211@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2212Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2213contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2214function treatment.
2215
2216If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2217registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2218GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2219used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2220in this vector.
2221
2222Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2223the treatment of leaf functions.
2224@end defmac
2225
2226@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2227A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2228should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2229
2230If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2231function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2232will cause the compiler to abort.
2233
2234Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2235treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2236this.
2237@end defmac
2238
2239@findex current_function_is_leaf
2240@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2241@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2242@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2243specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2244which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2245set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2246compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2247@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2248functions which only use leaf registers.
2249@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2250that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2251@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2252@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2253@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2254
2255@node Stack Registers
2256@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2257
2258There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2259``registers'' form a stack.  Stack registers are normally written by
2260pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2261stack.
2262
2263Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2264they must be consecutively numbered.  Furthermore, the existing
2265support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2266point coprocessor.  If you have a new architecture that uses
2267stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2268@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2269with it, as well as defining these macros.
2270
2271@defmac STACK_REGS
2272Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2273@end defmac
2274
2275@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2276This is a cover class containing the stack registers.  Define this if
2277the machine has any stack-like registers.
2278@end defmac
2279
2280@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2281The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2282of the stack.
2283@end defmac
2284
2285@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2286The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2287the stack.
2288@end defmac
2289
2290@node Register Classes
2291@section Register Classes
2292@cindex register class definitions
2293@cindex class definitions, register
2294
2295On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2296For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2297certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2298restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2299
2300You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2301which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2302that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2303
2304@findex ALL_REGS
2305@findex NO_REGS
2306In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2307class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2308class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2309union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2310
2311@findex GENERAL_REGS
2312One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2313terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2314@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2315the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2316to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2317
2318Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2319then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2320
2321The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2322constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2323You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2324them in operand constraints.
2325
2326You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2327registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2328some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2329cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2330(@pxref{Costs}).
2331
2332You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2333instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2334either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2335certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2336which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2337or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2338class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2339
2340You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2341classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2342contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2343in their union.
2344
2345When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2346certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2347Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2348a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2349specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2350
2351Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2352instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2353each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2354mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2355single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2356this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2357instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2358single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2359@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2360
2361@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2362An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2363as enumerated values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2364must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2365@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2366tells how many classes there are.
2367
2368Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2369the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2370in many of the tables described below.
2371@end deftp
2372
2373@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2374The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2375
2376@smallexample
2377#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2378@end smallexample
2379@end defmac
2380
2381@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2382An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2383constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2384@end defmac
2385
2386@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2387An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2388which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2389@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2390register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2391
2392When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2393Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2394several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2395for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2396In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2397registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2398so on.
2399@end defmac
2400
2401@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2402A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2403@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2404which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2405register.
2406@end defmac
2407
2408@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2409A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2410base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2411which is the register value plus a displacement.
2412@end defmac
2413
2414@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2415This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2416the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner.  If
2417@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2418@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2419@end defmac
2420
2421@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2422A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2423base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2424register address.  You should define this macro if base plus index
2425addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2426@end defmac
2427
2428@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2429A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2430base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2431space @var{address_space} must belong.  @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2432define the context in which the base register occurs.  @var{outer_code} is
2433the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2434of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2435@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2436index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2437@end defmac
2438
2439@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2440A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2441index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2442address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2443added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2444@end defmac
2445
2446@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2447A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2448suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2449@end defmac
2450
2451@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2452A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2453that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2454@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2455reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2456you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2457@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2458addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2459@code{address_operand}.
2460@end defmac
2461
2462@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2463A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2464use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2465memory in mode @var{mode}.  It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2466pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register.  You should
2467define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2468than other base register uses.
2469
2470Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2471@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2472@end defmac
2473
2474@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2475A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2476suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2477memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2478This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2479that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2480appears in the memory reference.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2481immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2482address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2483@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the
2484corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2485@code{SCRATCH} otherwise.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2486that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2487@end defmac
2488
2489@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2490A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2491suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2492either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2493allocated such a hard register.
2494
2495The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2496the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2497two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2498labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2499labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2500may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2501looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2502only if neither labeling works.
2503@end defmac
2504
2505@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2506
2507@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2508A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2509to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2510@var{rclass}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2511another, smaller class.
2512
2513The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2514
2515Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2516example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2517for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2518@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2519Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2520
2521One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2522@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2523loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2524force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2525immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2526instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2527register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2528@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2529into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2530@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2531of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2532
2533If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2534through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2535to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2536reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2537this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2538the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2539@end deftypefn
2540
2541@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2542A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2545another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2546safe:
2547
2548@smallexample
2549#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2550@end smallexample
2551
2552Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2553example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2554for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2555@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2556Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2557
2558One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2559@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2560loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2561force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2562immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2563instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2564register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2565@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2566into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2567@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2568of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2569
2570If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2571through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2572to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2573reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2574this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2575the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2576@end defmac
2577
2578@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2579Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2580input reloads.
2581
2582The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2583argument.
2584
2585You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2586reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2587@end deftypefn
2588
2589@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2590A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2591to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2592@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2593ordinarily be used.
2594
2595Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2596there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2597
2598The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2599smaller class.
2600
2601Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2602require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2603@end defmac
2604
2605@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2606Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2607from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2608@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2609from general registers, but not memory.  Below, we shall be using the
2610term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2611directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2612register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2613destination.  An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2614source and destination.  Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2615reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2616and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2617intermediate register still holds the required value.
2618
2619Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2620allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2621register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2622address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2623when compiling PIC)@.  Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2624as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2625that being copied.  Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2626describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2627these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2628of the scratch register(s).
2629
2630In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2631
2632For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2633and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2634@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}.  For output reloads, this target
2635hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2636needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2637
2638If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2639an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2640return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2641If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2642If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2643that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2644
2645If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2646perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2647closest intermediate register.  Or if no intermediate register is
2648required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2649copy  from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2650
2651You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2652in the md file which performs the move.  Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2653and input of this copy, respectively.  Operands from operand 2 onward are
2654for scratch operands.  These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2655single-register-class
2656@c [later: or memory]
2657output constraint.
2658
2659When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2660hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2661register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2662have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2663
2664@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2665@c   the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2666@c   and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2667@c   alternative.  A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2668@c   against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2669@c   constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2670@c   arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2671@c   Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2672
2673
2674@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2675pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2676Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2677in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2678
2679Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2680currently not supported.  For the time being, you will have to continue
2681to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2682
2683@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2684copied.  If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2685(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2686Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2687of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2688forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2689@end deftypefn
2690
2691@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2692@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2693@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2694These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2695@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2696
2697These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2698target hook.  Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2699reload phase that it may
2700need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2701register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2702register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2703you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2704largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2705intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2706
2707If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2708intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2709was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2710class required.  If the
2711requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2712@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2713macros identically.
2714
2715The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2716Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2717can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2718@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2719macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2720
2721If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2722intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2723@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2724(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which were normally
2725implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2726@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2727register.
2728
2729These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2730register that
2731contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2732class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2733value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2734register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2735Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2736
2737@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2738pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2739Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2740in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2741
2742These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2743registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2744registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2745would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2746the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2747intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2748general registers.
2749@end defmac
2750
2751@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2752Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2753to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2754those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2755@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2756class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2757and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2758
2759Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2760@end defmac
2761
2762@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2763Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2764allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2765If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2766defined by this macro.
2767
2768Do not define this macro if you do not define
2769@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2770@end defmac
2771
2772@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2773When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2774registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2775hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2776load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2777same as that of @var{mode}.
2778
2779This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2780bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2781in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2782registers.
2783
2784However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2785the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2786differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2787widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2788suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2789details.
2790
2791Do not define this macro if you do not define
2792@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2793is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2794@end defmac
2795
2796@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2797A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2798to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2799registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2800
2801The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2802has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise.  On most machines, this
2803default should be used.  Only use this target hook to some other expression
2804if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2805hard registers were needed for spill registers.  If this target hook returns
2806@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2807@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2808register.  If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2809you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2810the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2811allocation.
2812@end deftypefn
2813
2814@hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2815A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2816of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2817
2818This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2819the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2820@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2821@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2822values in the class @var{rclass}.
2823
2824This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2825in the reload pass.
2826
2827The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2828in words.
2829@end deftypefn
2830
2831@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2832A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2833of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2834
2835This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2836the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2837should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2838@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2839
2840This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2841in the reload pass.
2842@end defmac
2843
2844@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2845If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2846a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2847
2848For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2849floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2850Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2851does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2852register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2853as below:
2854
2855@smallexample
2856#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2857  (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2858   ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2859@end smallexample
2860@end defmac
2861
2862@node Old Constraints
2863@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2864@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2865@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2866
2867Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2868of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2869Constraints}.  This mechanism is obsolete.  New ports should not use
2870it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2871
2872@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2873For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2874@var{c}, return the length.  This allows you to have register class /
2875constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2876you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2877constraints only.  The definition of this macro should use
2878DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2879to handle specially.
2880There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2881for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2882transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2883return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2884will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2885@end defmac
2886
2887@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2888A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2889letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2890value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2891the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2892corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2893to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2894@end defmac
2895
2896@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2897Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2898passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2899different variants.
2900@end defmac
2901
2902@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2903A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2904letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2905particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2906letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2907the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2908not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2909@var{value}.
2910@end defmac
2911
2912@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2913Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2914string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2915between different variants.
2916@end defmac
2917
2918@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2919A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2920letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2921(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2922
2923If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2924@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2925range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2926letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2927
2928@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2929@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2930or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2931between these kinds.
2932@end defmac
2933
2934@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2935Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2936string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2937between different variants.
2938@end defmac
2939
2940@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2941A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2942letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2943memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2944elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2945@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2946may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2947
2948If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2949if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2950constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2951constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2952
2953For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2954in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2955letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2956@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2957a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2958alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2959does not include r0 on the output.
2960@end defmac
2961
2962@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2963Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2964in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2965variants.
2966@end defmac
2967
2968@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2969A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2970letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2971be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2972
2973It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2974at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2975comprises a subset of all memory references including
2976all those whose address is simply a base register.  This allows the reload
2977pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2978type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2979
2980For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2981memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2982register.  The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2983@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2984If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2985a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2986reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2987into a base register if required.  This is analogous to the way
2988an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2989@end defmac
2990
2991@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2992A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2993letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2994@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2995be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2996
2997It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2998at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2999a subset of all memory addresses including
3000all those that consist of just a base register.  This allows the reload
3001pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3002type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3003
3004Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3005be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate.  It is treated
3006analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3007@end defmac
3008
3009@node Stack and Calling
3010@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3011@cindex calling conventions
3012
3013@c prevent bad page break with this line
3014This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3015
3016@menu
3017* Frame Layout::
3018* Exception Handling::
3019* Stack Checking::
3020* Frame Registers::
3021* Elimination::
3022* Stack Arguments::
3023* Register Arguments::
3024* Scalar Return::
3025* Aggregate Return::
3026* Caller Saves::
3027* Function Entry::
3028* Profiling::
3029* Tail Calls::
3030* Stack Smashing Protection::
3031@end menu
3032
3033@node Frame Layout
3034@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3035@cindex stack frame layout
3036@cindex frame layout
3037
3038@c prevent bad page break with this line
3039Here is the basic stack layout.
3040
3041@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3042Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3043pointer to a smaller address.
3044
3045When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3046compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3047definition used does not matter.
3048@end defmac
3049
3050@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3051This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3052on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
3053@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3054
3055The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3056and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
3057the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3058to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3059space for the next item on the stack.
3060
3061The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3062defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3063which is often wrong.
3064@end defmac
3065
3066@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3067Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3068are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3069@end defmac
3070
3071@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3072Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3073addresses on the stack.
3074@end defmac
3075
3076@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3077Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3078
3079If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3080subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3081Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3082value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3083@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3084@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
3085@end defmac
3086
3087@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3088Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3089The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3090
3091On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3092is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3093alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3094stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3095@end defmac
3096
3097@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3098Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3099outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
3100zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
3101
3102If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3103the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3104@end defmac
3105
3106@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3107Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3108address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3109function.
3110
3111If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3112the first argument's address.
3113@end defmac
3114
3115@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3116Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3117on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3118
3119The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3120length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
3121machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
3122@end defmac
3123
3124@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3125A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3126stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3127@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}.  If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3128default value will be used.  Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3129elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3130@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3131@end defmac
3132
3133@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3134A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3135frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
3136@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3137itself.
3138
3139If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3140of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3141address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3142@end defmac
3143
3144@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3145If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3146setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
3147on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3148before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
3149define this macro.
3150@end defmac
3151
3152@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3153This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3154the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3155The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3156machines.  One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3157@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3158@end deftypefn
3159
3160@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3161A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3162address for the current frame.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3163of the current frame.  This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3164You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3165as the frame pointer.  Most machines do not need to define it.
3166@end defmac
3167
3168@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3169A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3170address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3171the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3172frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3173@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3174
3175The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3176@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3177determine the return address of other frames.
3178@end defmac
3179
3180@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3181Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3182from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3183@end defmac
3184
3185@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3186A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3187incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3188prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3189value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3190the stack.
3191
3192You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3193debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3194
3195If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3196@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3197@end defmac
3198
3199@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3200A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3201number that may be used as an alternative return column.  The column
3202must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3203be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3204
3205This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3206general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3207frames.  Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3208over time.
3209@end defmac
3210
3211@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3212A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3213number that is considered to always have the value zero.  This should
3214only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3215someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3216terminate the stack backtrace.  New ports should avoid this.
3217@end defmac
3218
3219@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3220This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3221contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs.  The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3222info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3223@smallexample
3224(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3225@end smallexample
3226and
3227@smallexample
3228(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3229@end smallexample
3230to let the backend emit the call frame instructions.  @var{label} is
3231the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3232the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3233@end deftypefn
3234
3235@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3236A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3237from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3238frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
3239the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3240previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3241
3242You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3243debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3244@end defmac
3245
3246@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3247A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3248from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
3249final value should coincide with that calculated by
3250@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
3251during virtual register instantiation.
3252
3253The default value for this macro is
3254@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3255which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3256immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
3257some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3258and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3259
3260You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3261want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3262DWARF 2.
3263@end defmac
3264
3265@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3266If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3267in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3268The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3269@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3270
3271Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3272via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3273variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible.  If this macro is
3274defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3275based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer.  Only one
3276of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3277should be defined.
3278@end defmac
3279
3280@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3281If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3282in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3283in DWARF 2 debug information.  The default is zero.  A different value
3284may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3285@end defmac
3286
3287@node Exception Handling
3288@subsection Exception Handling Support
3289@cindex exception handling
3290
3291@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3292A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3293data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3294@var{N} registers are usable.
3295
3296The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3297handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
3298should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3299but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
33002 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3301
3302You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3303handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3304@end defmac
3305
3306@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3307A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3308to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3309This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3310It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3311
3312Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3313untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3314
3315Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3316by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3317this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3318stack location to be restored in place.  Otherwise, you must define
3319this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3320that provided by DWARF 2.
3321@end defmac
3322
3323@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3324A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3325to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3326return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3327
3328Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3329return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
3330address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3331the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3332frame.  If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3333been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3334target call frame.
3335
3336Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3337address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
3338the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3339
3340If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3341define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3342@end defmac
3343
3344@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3345If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3346to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3347exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3348using it to return to the exception handler.
3349@end defmac
3350
3351@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3352This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3353handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
3354that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3355and so may be read-only.
3356
3357@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3358@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3359The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3360as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3361
3362If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3363represented directly.
3364@end defmac
3365
3366@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3367This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3368to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3369Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3370be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3371
3372This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3373handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3374of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3375to be emitted.
3376@end defmac
3377
3378@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3379This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3380code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3381available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3382through signal frames.
3383
3384This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3385@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3386@file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3387@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
3388for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3389the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register
3390save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3391evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}.  If the frame cannot be decoded,
3392the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3393
3394For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3395@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3396@end defmac
3397
3398@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3399This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3400call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3401usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3402
3403This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3404@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3405@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3406for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive.  If the
3407@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3408be updated in @var{fs}.
3409@end defmac
3410
3411@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3412A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3413info to be given comdat linkage.  Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3414linkage is necessary.  The default is @code{0}.
3415@end defmac
3416
3417@node Stack Checking
3418@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3419
3420GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3421stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3422three ways:
3423
3424@enumerate
3425@item
3426If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3427will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3428at appropriate places in the configuration files.  GCC will not do
3429other special processing.
3430
3431@item
3432If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3433@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3434that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3435static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3436in the configuration files.  GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3437stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3438approach below.
3439
3440@item
3441If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3442``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3443@end enumerate
3444
3445If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3446GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3447@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3448dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3449
3450@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3451A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3452machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
3453is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3454checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach.  The default
3455value of this macro is zero.
3456@end defmac
3457
3458@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3459A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3460in a machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if you would
3461like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3462approach.  The default value of this macro is zero.
3463@end defmac
3464
3465@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3466An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3467instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer.  You will normally
3468define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3469the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The default value
3470of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3471@end defmac
3472
3473@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3474An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3475when doing probes.  This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3476contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3477thread at any point in time.  In this situation an alternate signal stack
3478is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow.  The
3479default value of this macro is zero.
3480@end defmac
3481
3482@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3483The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3484languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of 75 words
3485with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34868192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3487most machines.
3488@end defmac
3489
3490The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3491nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3492in the opposite case.
3493
3494@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3495The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
3496instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3497stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3498checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
3499default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3500systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3501@end defmac
3502
3503@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3504GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
3505represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3506space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3507You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3508use the default of four words.
3509@end defmac
3510
3511@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3512The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3513fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3514@option{-fstack-check}.
3515GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3516normally not need to override that default.
3517@end defmac
3518
3519@need 2000
3520@node Frame Registers
3521@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3522
3523@c prevent bad page break with this line
3524This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3525
3526@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3527The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3528fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
3529the hardware determines which register this is.
3530@end defmac
3531
3532@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3533The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3534access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
3535hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
3536choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3537@end defmac
3538
3539@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3540On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3541offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3542allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3543between these two locations).  On those machines, define
3544@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3545be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3546@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3547used for the frame pointer.
3548
3549You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3550is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3551the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3552completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3553definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3554@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3555or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3556
3557Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3558@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3559@end defmac
3560
3561@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3562The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3563the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
3564frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
3565register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
3566wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
3567pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3568@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3569(@pxref{Elimination}).
3570@end defmac
3571
3572@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3573Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3574@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3575the same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3576== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3577definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3578@end defmac
3579
3580@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3581Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3582@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3583same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3584ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3585definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3586@end defmac
3587
3588@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3589The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3590access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
3591machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3592pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
3593to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3594@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3595
3596Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3597address from the stack.
3598@end defmac
3599
3600@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3601@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3602Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
3603register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3604function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3605number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
3606these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3607not be defined.
3608
3609The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3610
3611If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3612defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3613@end defmac
3614
3615@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3616This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3617targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3618nested functions.  This may be required if the target has function
3619attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3620those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3621
3622The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3623
3624If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3625provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3626Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3627from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3628will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3629@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3630@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3631@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3632The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3633@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3634to refer to those items.
3635@end deftypefn
3636
3637@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3638This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3639saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3640DWARF2 exception handling.
3641
3642Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3643exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3644extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3645in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3646used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3647routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3648registers that are not call-saved.
3649
3650If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3651@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3652@end defmac
3653
3654@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3655
3656This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3657for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3658
3659If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3660@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3661@end defmac
3662
3663@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3664
3665Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3666is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3667Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3668column number to use instead.
3669
3670See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3671@end defmac
3672
3673@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3674
3675Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3676used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3677debug info sections.  Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3678should return the .eh_frame register number.  The default is
3679@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3680
3681@end defmac
3682
3683@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3684
3685Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3686that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3687should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3688.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero).  The default is to
3689return @code{@var{regno}}.
3690
3691@end defmac
3692
3693@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3694
3695Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3696@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context.  It should be defined if
3697target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}.  The
3698default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3699
3700@end defmac
3701
3702@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3703
3704Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3705context with version, args_size and by_value fields.  If it is undefined,
3706it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3707defined and 0 otherwise.
3708
3709@end defmac
3710
3711@node Elimination
3712@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3713
3714@c prevent bad page break with this line
3715This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3716
3717@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3718This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3719a frame pointer.  This target hook is called in the reload pass.  If its return
3720value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3721
3722This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3723according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3724constant @code{true} suffices.  Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3725to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3726Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3727pointer.
3728
3729In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3730without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3731automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3732@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns.  You don't need to worry about
3733them.
3734
3735In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3736register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3737fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3738
3739Default return value is @code{false}.
3740@end deftypefn
3741
3742@findex get_frame_size
3743@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3744A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3745between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3746the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3747such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3748registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3749
3750If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3751need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3752@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3753case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3754@end defmac
3755
3756@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3757If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3758eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3759defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3760references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3761
3762The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3763of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3764
3765On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3766the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3767must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3768replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3769depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3770
3771In this case, you might specify:
3772@smallexample
3773#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3774@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3775 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3776 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3777@end smallexample
3778
3779Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3780specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3781@end defmac
3782
3783@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3784This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3785try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3786@var{to_reg}.  This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3787is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3788preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3789knows about.
3790
3791Default return value is @code{true}.
3792@end deftypefn
3793
3794@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3795This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3796specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3797registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3798defined.
3799@end defmac
3800
3801@node Stack Arguments
3802@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3803@cindex arguments on stack
3804@cindex stack arguments
3805
3806The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3807on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3808control passing certain arguments in registers.
3809
3810@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3811This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3812prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3813passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3814cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3815The default is to not promote prototypes.
3816@end deftypefn
3817
3818@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3819A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3820outgoing arguments.
3821If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3822That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3823allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3824it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3825@end defmac
3826
3827@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3828A C expression.  If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3829last to first, rather than from first to last.  If this macro is not
3830defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3831and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3832@end defmac
3833
3834@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3835A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3836stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3837
3838On some machines, the definition
3839
3840@smallexample
3841#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3842@end smallexample
3843
3844@noindent
3845will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3846to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3847alignment.  Then the definition should be
3848
3849@smallexample
3850#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3851@end smallexample
3852
3853If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3854@end defmac
3855
3856@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3857@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3858A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3859will be computed and placed into the variable
3860@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3861onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3862increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3863
3864Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3865is not proper.
3866@end defmac
3867
3868@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3869Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3870allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3871registers.
3872
3873The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3874arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3875which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3876The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3877of the function.
3878
3879This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3880machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3881which.
3882@end defmac
3883@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3884@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3885
3886@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3887Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3888caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3889when calling a function of @var{fntype}.  @var{fntype} may be NULL
3890if the function called is a library function.
3891
3892If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3893whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3894@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3895@end defmac
3896
3897@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3898Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3899stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3900@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3901@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3902
3903Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3904stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3905suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3906stack in its natural location.
3907@end defmac
3908
3909@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3910This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3911a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3912and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3913
3914@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3915the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3916@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3917From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3918
3919@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3920describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3921@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3922From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3923arguments (if known).
3924
3925When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3926will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3927you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3928by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3929a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3930in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3931
3932@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3933stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3934argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3935
3936On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3937of this macro is @var{size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3938calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3939the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3940convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3941arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3942nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3943@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3944number of arguments.
3945@end deftypefn
3946
3947@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3948A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3949pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3950when compiling a function call.
3951
3952@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3953have been accumulated.
3954
3955On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3956that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3957that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3958call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3959appropriate.
3960@end defmac
3961
3962@node Register Arguments
3963@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3964@cindex arguments in registers
3965@cindex registers arguments
3966
3967This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3968types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3969the stack.
3970
3971@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3972Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3973register and if so, which register.
3974
3975The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3976arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3977the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3978(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3979which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3980nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3981function's prototype.  @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3982syntax error has previously occurred.
3983
3984The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3985register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3986on the stack.
3987
3988The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3989used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3990@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3991@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3992describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3993@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3994register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3995register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3996second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3997the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3998As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3999RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
4000argument is also stored on the stack.
4001
4002The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4003VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4004pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4005
4006@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4007The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4008machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4009cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is
4010done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4011@var{named} is @code{false}.
4012
4013@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4014@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4015You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4016in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4017type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4018is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4019argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4020defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4021a register.
4022@end deftypefn
4023
4024@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4025This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4026solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4027definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4028documentation.
4029@end deftypefn
4030
4031@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4032Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4033that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4034necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4035argument.
4036
4037For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4038which the caller passes the value, and
4039@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4040fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4041arrive.
4042
4043If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4044@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4045@end deftypefn
4046
4047@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4048This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4049argument that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
4050arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4051pushed on the stack.
4052
4053On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4054registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
4055first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4056on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4057structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4058in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
4059compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4060
4061@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4062register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4063@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4064@end deftypefn
4065
4066@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
4067This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4068position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference.  This
4069predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4070passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4071
4072If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4073pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4074The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4075to that type.
4076@end deftypefn
4077
4078@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4079The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4080known to be passed by reference.  The hook should return true if the
4081function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4082by the caller.
4083
4084For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4085determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4086not be generated.
4087
4088The default version of this hook always returns false.
4089@end deftypefn
4090
4091@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4092A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4093of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some
4094target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4095of bytes of argument so far.
4096
4097There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4098arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
4099variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
4100arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4101@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4102should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4103@end defmac
4104
4105@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4106If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4107function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4108created.  The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4109reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4110If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4111@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4112@end defmac
4113
4114@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4115A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4116@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The
4117variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype}
4118is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4119the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4120For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4121declaration node of the function.  @var{fndecl} is also set when
4122@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4123being compiled.  @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4124arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4125parameter, when making a call.  When processing incoming arguments,
4126@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4127
4128When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4129@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4130contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
4131an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
4132macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4133never both of them at once.
4134@end defmac
4135
4136@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4137Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4138it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4139@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
4140is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41410)} is used instead.
4142@end defmac
4143
4144@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4145Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4146finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
4147undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4148
4149The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4150with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
4151argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4152@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4153@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4154@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
4155@end defmac
4156
4157@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4158This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4159advance past an argument in the argument list.  The values @var{mode},
4160@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.  Once this is done,
4161the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4162argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4163
4164This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4165on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4166used for arguments without any special help.
4167@end deftypefn
4168
4169@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4170If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4171offset of the argument passed in memory.  This is needed for the SPU,
4172which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4173slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4174top.
4175@end defmac
4176
4177@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4178If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4179to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
4180@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4181@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4182
4183The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4184target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}.  It is
4185always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4186
4187This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4188For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
4189big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4190constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4191@end defmac
4192
4193@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4194If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4195implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4196next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4197controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
4198arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4199@end defmac
4200
4201@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4202Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4203memory.  @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element.  Defining this
4204macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4205machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl.  In particular,
4206@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4207registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register;  For example,
4208a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4209required.
4210@end defmac
4211
4212@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
4213This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4214with the specified mode and type.  The default hook returns
4215@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4216@end deftypefn
4217
4218@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
4219
4220@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4221A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4222register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
4223@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4224the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
4225used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4226stack.
4227@end defmac
4228
4229@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4230This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4231as two scalar parameters.  By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4232arguments into the target's word size.  Some ABIs require complex arguments
4233to be split and treated as their individual components.  For example, on
4234AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4235registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4236point register.
4237
4238The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4239false.
4240@end deftypefn
4241
4242@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4243This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4244The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4245@end deftypefn
4246
4247@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
4248This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4249to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4250variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4251to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4252variable.
4253The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4254this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4255internal type.
4256If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4257Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4258macro to iterate through all types.
4259@end deftypefn
4260
4261@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4262This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4263@var{fndecl}.
4264The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4265@end deftypefn
4266
4267@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4268This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4269type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4270@code{NULL_TREE}.
4271@end deftypefn
4272
4273@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4274This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4275@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}.  The first two parameters correspond to the
4276arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4277@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4278@end deftypefn
4279
4280@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4281Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4282with machine mode @var{mode}.  The default version of this
4283hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4284@end deftypefn
4285
4286@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4287
4288@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4289Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4290insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}.  For a scalar mode to be
4291considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4292must work.
4293
4294The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4295required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4296Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4297code in @file{optabs.c}.
4298@end deftypefn
4299
4300@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4301Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4302insns involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it
4303must have move patterns for this mode.
4304@end deftypefn
4305
4306@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4307
4308@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4309Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4310small register classes.  If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4311@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4312in @var{mode}.  The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4313In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4314for any mode.
4315
4316On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4317insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4318to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4319if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4320insn.
4321
4322Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4323in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4324the instruction are already known.  And for some machines, register
4325classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4326registers.  For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4327registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4328SSE registers for floating point operations.  On such targets, a good
4329strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4330machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4331
4332The default version of this hook returns false for any mode.  It is always
4333safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value.  But if you
4334unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4335that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this hook
4336to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4337of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4338@end deftypefn
4339
4340@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4341
4342@node Scalar Return
4343@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4344@cindex return values in registers
4345@cindex values, returned by functions
4346@cindex scalars, returned as values
4347
4348This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4349values---values that can fit in registers.
4350
4351@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4352
4353Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4354returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4355representing a data type.  @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4356representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4357function being called.  If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4358compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4359Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4360a function returns a value.
4361
4362On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4363(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4364place regardless of mode.)  The value of the expression is usually a
4365@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4366The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4367multiple places.  See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4368@code{parallel} form.   Note that the callee will populate every
4369location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4370the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4371that element as the canonical location and ignore the others.  The m68k
4372port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4373@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4374
4375If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4376the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4377@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4378
4379If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4380node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4381pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4382convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4383known.
4384
4385Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4386which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4387the caller sees the value.  For such machines, you should return
4388different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4389
4390@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4391aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
4392@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4393@end deftypefn
4394
4395@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4396This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4397a new target instead.
4398@end defmac
4399
4400@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4401A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4402function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4403
4404Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4405support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4406specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4407compiled.
4408@end defmac
4409
4410@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4411Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4412function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4413
4414The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4415library function is given by @var{fun}.  The hook should return an RTX
4416representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4417
4418If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4419@end deftypefn
4420
4421@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4422A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4423register in which the values of called function may come back.
4424
4425A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4426second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4427recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
4428suffices:
4429
4430@smallexample
4431#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4432@end smallexample
4433
4434If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4435function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4436should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4437
4438This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4439for a new target instead.
4440@end defmac
4441
4442@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4443A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4444register in which the values of called function may come back.
4445
4446A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4447second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4448recognized by this target hook.
4449
4450If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4451function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4452should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4453
4454If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4455@end deftypefn
4456
4457@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4458Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4459need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4460saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4461@end defmac
4462
4463@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4464This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4465at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4466padded at the least significant end).  You can assume that @var{type}
4467is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4468
4469Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4470be able to hold the complete return value.  For example, if a 1-, 2-
4471or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44724-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4473@code{SImode} rtx.
4474@end deftypefn
4475
4476@node Aggregate Return
4477@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4478@cindex aggregates as return values
4479@cindex large return values
4480@cindex returning aggregate values
4481@cindex structure value address
4482
4483When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4484cases), the value is not returned according to
4485@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the
4486caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4487should be stored.  This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4488address}.
4489
4490This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4491memory.
4492
4493@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4494This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4495function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4496Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4497will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4498libcalls.
4499
4500Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4501by this function.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4502takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
4503possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4504definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4505values, and 0 otherwise.
4506
4507Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4508be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4509to indicate this.
4510@end deftypefn
4511
4512@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4513Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4514in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4515only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4516If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4517and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4518target hook.
4519
4520If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4521@end defmac
4522
4523@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4524This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4525address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4526passed as an ``invisible'' first argument.  Note that @var{fndecl} may
4527be @code{NULL}, for libcalls.  You do not need to define this target
4528hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4529argument.
4530
4531On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4532is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4533caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
4534be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4535@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4536the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4537the caller.
4538
4539If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4540stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4541@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4542structure value address at the beginning of a function.  If you need
4543to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4544@end deftypefn
4545
4546@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4547Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4548for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4549the address of a static variable containing the value.
4550
4551Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4552pass an address to the subroutine.
4553
4554This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4555nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4556@end defmac
4557
4558@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4559
4560@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4561
4562@node Caller Saves
4563@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4564
4565If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
4566makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4567must live across calls.
4568
4569@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4570A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4571a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4572restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
4573this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4574
4575If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4576machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4577@end defmac
4578
4579@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4580A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4581of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
4582@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4583returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4584will select the smallest suitable mode.
4585@end defmac
4586
4587@node Function Entry
4588@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4589@cindex function entry and exit
4590@cindex prologue
4591@cindex epilogue
4592
4593This section describes the macros that output function entry
4594(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4595
4596@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4597If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4598function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4599initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4600saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4601local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
4602stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4603
4604The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4605macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
4606
4607@findex regs_ever_live
4608To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4609@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4610@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
4611prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4612call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4613@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4614
4615On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4616not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4617they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4618appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4619registers are used in the function.
4620
4621@findex frame_pointer_needed
4622On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4623function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4624pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
4625frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4626@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
4627time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
4628
4629The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4630required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
4631listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4632order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4633stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4634the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
4635for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4636compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
4637or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4638need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4639@end deftypefn
4640
4641@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4642If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4643prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
4644emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4645emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4646@end deftypefn
4647
4648@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4649If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4650epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4651emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4652emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4653@end deftypefn
4654
4655@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4656If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4657function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4658registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4659called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
4660same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4661registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4662@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4663
4664On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4665of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
4666instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4667@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4668
4669Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4670@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
4671switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4672define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4673target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4674condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4675
4676On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4677function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
4678two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
4679is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4680@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4681a function that needs a frame pointer.
4682
4683Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4684@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4685The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4686function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4687
4688On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4689others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
4690given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4691number of arguments.
4692
4693@findex current_function_pops_args
4694Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4695functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4696needs to know what was decided.  The number of bytes of the current
4697function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4698@code{crtl->args.pops_args}.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
4699@end deftypefn
4700
4701@itemize @bullet
4702@item
4703@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4704A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4705uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4706stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4707if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4708arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4709yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
4710region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4711registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4712features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4713
4714@item
4715An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4716The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4717the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4718machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4719in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
4720a save area.
4721
4722@item
4723A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4724boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
4725this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4726save area closer to the top of the stack.
4727
4728@item
4729@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4730Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4731@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4732argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4733@end itemize
4734
4735@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4736Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4737instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4738pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4739adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.  The
4740default is 0.
4741
4742Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4743frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
4744stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4745compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4746@end defmac
4747
4748@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4749Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4750used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
4751pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4752@end defmac
4753
4754@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4755Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4756used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4757on entry to an exception edge.
4758@end defmac
4759
4760@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4761Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4762instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
4763definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4764representing the number of delay slots there.
4765@end defmac
4766
4767@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4768A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4769slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4770
4771The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4772being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4773eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
4774of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4775If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4776may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
4777(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4778slot.
4779
4780@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4781@findex final_scan_insn
4782The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4783list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4784@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
4785delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
4786@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4787outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4788@code{final_scan_insn}.
4789
4790You need not define this macro if you did not define
4791@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4792@end defmac
4793
4794@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4795A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4796function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4797inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4798adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4799the real function.
4800
4801First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4802contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4803contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4804in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4805e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4806all other incoming arguments.
4807
4808Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4809made after adding @code{delta}.  In particular, if @var{p} is the
4810adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4811
4812@smallexample
4813p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4814@end smallexample
4815
4816After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4817@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4818not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4819return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4820
4821The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4822the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4823of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4824and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4825
4826The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4827have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4828some targets, but probably not.
4829
4830If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4831front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4832@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4833not support varargs.
4834@end deftypefn
4835
4836@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4837A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4838to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4839arguments it is passed, and false otherwise.  In the latter case, the
4840generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4841previously exposed.
4842@end deftypefn
4843
4844@node Profiling
4845@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4846@cindex profiling, code generation
4847
4848These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4849
4850@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4851A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4852assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4853
4854@findex mcount
4855The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4856your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4857compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4858compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4859
4860Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4861variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4862@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4863the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4864@end defmac
4865
4866@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4867A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4868code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4869not support profiling.
4870@end defmac
4871
4872@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4873Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4874@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4875allocated for each function.  This is true for almost all modern
4876implementations.  If you define this macro, you must not use the
4877@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4878@end defmac
4879
4880@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4881Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4882the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4883@end defmac
4884
4885@node Tail Calls
4886@subsection Permitting tail calls
4887@cindex tail calls
4888
4889@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4890True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4891call expression @var{exp}.  @var{decl} will be the called function,
4892or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4893
4894It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4895tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4896during PIC compilation.  The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4897as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4898``normal'' call.  The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4899may vary greatly between different architectures.
4900@end deftypefn
4901
4902@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4903Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4904function.  This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4905cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4906registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4907TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4908FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4909@end deftypefn
4910
4911@hook TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE
4912
4913@node Stack Smashing Protection
4914@subsection Stack smashing protection
4915@cindex stack smashing protection
4916
4917@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4918This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4919for the stack protection guard.  This variable is initialized by the
4920runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4921that is placed at the top of the local stack frame.  The type of this
4922variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4923
4924The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4925@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4926@end deftypefn
4927
4928@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4929This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4930stack protect guard variable has been modified.  This expression should
4931involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4932
4933The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4934@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments.  This function is
4935normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4936@end deftypefn
4937
4938@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4939
4940@node Varargs
4941@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4942@cindex varargs implementation
4943
4944GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4945@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4946on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
4947varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4948conditionals to include it.
4949
4950ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4951the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
4952implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4953to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
4954@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
4955supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4956
4957However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
4958the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4959below.
4960
4961@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4962Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4963that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
4964versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4965you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4966
4967On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4968control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On
4969other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4970found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4971
4972Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4973beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4974@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4975This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4976to use them for its own purposes.
4977@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4978@c 10feb93
4979@end defmac
4980
4981@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4982This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4983argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4984returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4985argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4986fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4987verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4988of the current function.
4989@end defmac
4990
4991@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4992Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4993passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4994has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
4995specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4996with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4997
4998@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4999considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
5000kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5001
5002The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5003interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5004@end defmac
5005
5006These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5007
5008@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5009If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5010@code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the very
5011beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.  The
5012return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5013to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5014@end deftypefn
5015
5016@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5017This target hook offers an alternative to using
5018@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5019@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the anonymous
5020register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5021have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is done, you can
5022use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5023pass all their arguments on the stack.
5024
5025The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5026structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5027named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5028last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5029
5030The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5031argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5032store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5033variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you
5034store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5035frame.
5036
5037Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5038compile time without knowing their data types,
5039@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5040have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5041for all data types.
5042
5043If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5044arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
5045happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5046end of the source file.  The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5047not generate any instructions in this case.
5048@end deftypefn
5049
5050@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5051Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5052argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5053
5054This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5055is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this hook returns
5056@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5057arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns @code{false},
5058but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5059then all arguments are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments
5060except the last are treated as named.
5061
5062You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5063@end deftypefn
5064
5065@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5066If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5067@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5068@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5069defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5070@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5071Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5072@end deftypefn
5073
5074@node Trampolines
5075@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5076@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5077@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5078
5079A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5080when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
5081the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
5082tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5083trampoline.
5084
5085The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5086address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5087the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5088two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
5089exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
5090machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5091two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5092operands.
5093
5094The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5095parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5096immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
5097simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5098proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
5099may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5100separately.
5101
5102@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5103This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5104on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5105the constant parts of a trampoline.  This code should not include a
5106label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5107
5108If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5109for the target.  Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5110code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5111to generate it on the spot.
5112@end deftypefn
5113
5114@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5115Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5116(@pxref{Sections}).  The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5117@end defmac
5118
5119@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5120A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5121@end defmac
5122
5123@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5124Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5125
5126If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5127is used for aligning trampolines.
5128@end defmac
5129
5130@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5131This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5132@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5133is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5134RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5135when it is called.
5136
5137If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5138first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5139from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5140Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5141trampoline.  If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5142to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5143
5144If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5145enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5146initializing the trampoline proper.
5147@end deftypefn
5148
5149@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5150This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5151the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address of the
5152memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}.  In case
5153the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5154address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5155be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5156If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5157@end deftypefn
5158
5159Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5160separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
5161fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5162jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5163
5164Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
5165the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
5166make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5167subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5168latter makes initialization faster.
5169
5170To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5171the following macro.
5172
5173@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5174If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5175cache} in the specified interval.  The definition of this macro would
5176typically be a series of @code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and
5177@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5178@end defmac
5179
5180To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
5181you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5182cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5183beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5184its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5185
5186@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5187Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5188work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5189which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
5190@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5191
5192If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5193C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5194special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
5195statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5196global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5197special assembler code.
5198@end defmac
5199
5200@node Library Calls
5201@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5202@cindex library subroutine names
5203@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5204
5205@c prevent bad page break with this line
5206Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5207
5208@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5209This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5210expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a.  It can be used to
5211provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5212are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5213@end defmac
5214
5215@findex set_optab_libfunc
5216@findex init_one_libfunc
5217@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5218This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5219existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5220@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5221@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5222library routines.
5223
5224The default is to do nothing.  Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5225@end deftypefn
5226
5227@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5228
5229@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5230This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5231implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5232mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5233return a tristate.
5234
5235GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5236comparison operators, so the default returns false always.  Most ports
5237don't need to define this macro.
5238@end defmac
5239
5240@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5241This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5242functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5243operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5244and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5245If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5246@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2.  If the target uses the routines
5247in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5248@end defmac
5249
5250@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5251@findex matherr
5252@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5253The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5254expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5255deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
5256@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5257system.
5258
5259If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5260domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5261error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5262there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5263that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5264@end defmac
5265
5266@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5267@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5268Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5269refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
5270@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
5271macro, a reasonable default is used.
5272@end defmac
5273
5274@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5275@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5276When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5277@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard.  The
5278default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5279functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5280systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5281@end defmac
5282
5283@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5284@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5285When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5286and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}.  The
5287default is zero.  The target has to provide the following functions:
5288@smallexample
5289void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5290void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5291void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5292@end smallexample
5293@end defmac
5294
5295@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5296Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5297by default.  This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5298and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5299This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5300the NeXT runtime installed.
5301
5302If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5303will be used by default.  This convention passes just the object and the
5304selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5305
5306In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5307scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5308@end defmac
5309
5310@node Addressing Modes
5311@section Addressing Modes
5312@cindex addressing modes
5313
5314@c prevent bad page break with this line
5315This is about addressing modes.
5316
5317@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5318@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5319@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5320@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5321A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5322pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5323@end defmac
5324
5325@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5326@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5327A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5328post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5329the size of the memory operand.
5330@end defmac
5331
5332@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5333@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5334A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5335post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5336@end defmac
5337
5338@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5339A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5340is a valid address.  On most machines the default definition of
5341@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5342is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5343constant addresses are supported.
5344@end defmac
5345
5346@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5347@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5348accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5349known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5350expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5351@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5352@end defmac
5353
5354@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5355A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5356memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5357the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5358accept.
5359@end defmac
5360
5361@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5362A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5363address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5364
5365Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5366non-strict one.  The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5367desired by the caller.
5368
5369The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It must be defined so
5370that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5371considered a memory reference.  This is because in contexts where some
5372kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5373must be rejected.  For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5374up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5375register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5376if the array holds @code{-1}.
5377
5378The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
5379accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5380register is required.
5381
5382Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5383and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5384constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5385specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
5386recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5387
5388Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5389sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
5390@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5391naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5392be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5393
5394@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5395On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5396the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
5397target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5398into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
5399@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5400@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
5401Format}.
5402
5403@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5404Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5405this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro.  This macro
5406has this syntax:
5407
5408@example
5409#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5410@end example
5411
5412@noindent
5413and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5414address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5415
5416@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5417Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5418macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
5419@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5420that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5421
5422Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5423files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5424@end deftypefn
5425
5426@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5427A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5428character for general memory addresses.  This defines the constraint
5429letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5430@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}.  Define this macro if you want to
5431support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5432semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint.  This is necessary in order to
5433preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5434@code{'m'} constraint.
5435@end defmac
5436
5437@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5438A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5439or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5440can easily find the base term.  This macro is used in only two places:
5441@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5442
5443It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
5444that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5445
5446The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5447a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5448@end defmac
5449
5450@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5451This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5452operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5453address.
5454
5455@findex break_out_memory_refs
5456@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5457and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5458@var{x}.
5459
5460The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5461@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5462should return the new @var{x}.
5463
5464It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5465The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In fact, it
5466is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5467a valid way to legitimize the address.  But often a machine-dependent
5468strategy can generate better code.
5469@end deftypefn
5470
5471@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5472A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5473that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5474@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5475It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5476performance reasons.
5477
5478For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5479reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5480registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
5481processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5482needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
5483@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5484generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5485be shared.
5486
5487@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
5488to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5489and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5490of reload internals.
5491
5492@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5493previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
5494then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5495
5496@findex push_reload
5497The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5498need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5499suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5500
5501The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5502@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5503should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5504This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5505@code{push_reload}.
5506
5507@findex strict_memory_address_p
5508The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5509the address has become legitimate.
5510
5511@findex copy_rtx
5512If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5513this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that it unshares only a
5514single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5515top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5516It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5517address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5518@end defmac
5519
5520@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5521This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5522different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5523reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5524but not others.
5525
5526Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5527effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5528of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5529addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5530
5531You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5532
5533The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5534@end deftypefn
5535
5536@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5537A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5538@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5539different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5540reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5541but not others.
5542
5543Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5544effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5545of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5546addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5547
5548You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5549
5550These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5551@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5552@end defmac
5553
5554@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5555This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5556@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
5557@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5558
5559The default definition returns true.
5560@end deftypefn
5561
5562@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5563This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5564@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5565macros.  Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5566references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5567addressing modes.  This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5568the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5569into their original form.
5570@end deftypefn
5571
5572@hook TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P
5573This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5574debug sections.
5575@end deftypefn
5576
5577@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5578This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5579should not) be spilled to the constant pool.  @var{mode} is the mode
5580of @var{x}.
5581
5582The default version of this hook returns false.
5583
5584The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5585deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5586from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5587holding the constant.  This restriction is often true of addresses
5588of TLS symbols for various targets.
5589@end deftypefn
5590
5591@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5592This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5593be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.  @var{mode} is the mode
5594of @var{x}.
5595
5596The default version returns false for all constants.
5597@end deftypefn
5598
5599@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
5600This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5601the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5602@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.  @var{md_fn} is true
5603when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function.  When
5604@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5605of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5606function are valid.
5607@end deftypefn
5608
5609@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5610This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5611address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5612used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5613@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5614
5615The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5616@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5617the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5618@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5619two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5620@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5621the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5622from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5623@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5624@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5625@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5626
5627If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5628to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5629use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5630@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5631should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5632described above.
5633If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5634the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5635log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5636@end deftypefn
5637
5638@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5639This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5640widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5641
5642If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5643@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5644widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5645preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5646@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5647@end deftypefn
5648
5649@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5650This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5651widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5652
5653If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5654@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5655widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5656preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5657@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5658@end deftypefn
5659
5660@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5661Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5662For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5663misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5664@end deftypefn
5665
5666@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5667Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5668@end deftypefn
5669
5670@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK
5671Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5672@end deftypefn
5673
5674@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5675This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5676input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5677The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5678specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5679(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5680
5681If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5682@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5683conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5684@end deftypefn
5685
5686@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5687This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5688vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5689@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5690The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration.  The
5691return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5692@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5693@end deftypefn
5694
5695@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5696This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5697store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5698parameter.  The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5699the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}.  @var{is_packed}
5700parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5701@end deftypefn
5702
5703@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5704This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5705mode @var{mode}.  The default is
5706equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5707transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5708@end deftypefn
5709
5710@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5711This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5712after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5713mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5714The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5715@end deftypefn
5716
5717@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD
5718
5719@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE
5720
5721@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER
5722Target builtin that implements vector gather operation.  @var{mem_vectype}
5723is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5724the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5725The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5726loads.
5727@end deftypefn
5728
5729@node Anchored Addresses
5730@section Anchored Addresses
5731@cindex anchored addresses
5732@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5733
5734GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5735For example, if we have:
5736
5737@smallexample
5738static int a, b, c;
5739int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5740@end smallexample
5741
5742the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5743addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}.  On some targets,
5744it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5745the three variables relative to it.  The equivalent pseudocode would
5746be something like:
5747
5748@smallexample
5749int foo (void)
5750@{
5751  register int *xr = &x;
5752  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5753@}
5754@end smallexample
5755
5756(which isn't valid C).  We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5757``section anchors''.  Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5758
5759The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5760in order to make effective use of section anchors.  It won't use
5761section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5762or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5763
5764@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5765The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5766On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5767applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5768for every mode.  The default value is 0.
5769@end deftypevr
5770
5771@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5772Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5773offset that should be applied to section anchors.  The default
5774value is 0.
5775@end deftypevr
5776
5777@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5778Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5779@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5780The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5781of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5782
5783If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5784it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5785If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5786is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5787@end deftypefn
5788
5789@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5790Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5791@var{x}.  You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5792@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5793
5794The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5795intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5796or target-specific sections.
5797@end deftypefn
5798
5799@node Condition Code
5800@section Condition Code Status
5801@cindex condition code status
5802
5803The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5804two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5805
5806The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5807(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5808clobber of the condition codes.  The second is the condition code
5809register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5810architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5811most instructions do not affect it.  The latter category includes
5812most RISC machines.
5813
5814The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5815the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5816insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}.  This can prevent important
5817optimizations on some machines.  For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5818is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5819three instructions earlier than the conditional branch.  The instruction
5820scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5821separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5822
5823For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5824represent the condition code for new ports.  If there is a specific
5825condition code register in the machine, use a hard register.  If the
5826condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5827or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5828Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5829that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5830
5831Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5832specified already in the compare instruction.  In this case, you are not
5833interested in most macros in this section.
5834
5835@menu
5836* CC0 Condition Codes::      Old style representation of condition codes.
5837* MODE_CC Condition Codes::  Modern representation of condition codes.
5838* Cond Exec Macros::         Macros to control conditional execution.
5839@end menu
5840
5841@node CC0 Condition Codes
5842@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5843@findex cc0
5844
5845@findex cc_status
5846The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5847describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5848the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
5849variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5850currently based, and several standard flags.
5851
5852Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5853description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
5854information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5855
5856@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5857C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5858component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
5859
5860This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5861@end defmac
5862
5863@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5864A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5865The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5866the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
5867define this macro to initialize it.
5868
5869This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5870@end defmac
5871
5872@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5873A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5874appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
5875this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5876code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5877set @code{(cc0)}.
5878
5879This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5880
5881If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5882other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5883invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5884reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5885registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5886@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5887insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5888based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5889value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
5890this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5891@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5892@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5893condition code value.
5894
5895The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5896with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5897@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5898constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
5899insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
5900@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5901@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5902
5903A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5904that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5905@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5906two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5907@end defmac
5908
5909@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5910@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5911@findex CCmode
5912@findex MODE_CC
5913
5914@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5915On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5916than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5917code set by a subtract instruction.  However, on some machines
5918when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5919bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5920branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches.  When
5921this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5922record different formats of the condition code register.  Modes can
5923also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5924unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5925
5926If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5927@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5928a mode given an operand of a compare.  This is needed because the modes
5929have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5930by instruction combination.  The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5931be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5932the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5933
5934@smallexample
5935(define_insn ""
5936  [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5937        (compare:CC_NOOV
5938          (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5939                   (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5940          (const_int 0)))]
5941  ""
5942  "@dots{}")
5943@end smallexample
5944
5945@noindent
5946together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5947for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5948
5949@smallexample
5950#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5951  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
5952   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
5953   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
5954       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5955      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5956@end smallexample
5957
5958Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5959were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5960this section.
5961
5962You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5963in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5964@end defmac
5965
5966@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5967On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5968convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
5969does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5970comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5971
5972On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5973required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5974and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5975comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5976@var{op1} as required.
5977
5978GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5979valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5980@file{md} file.
5981
5982You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5983code or operands.
5984@end defmac
5985
5986@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5987A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5988comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5989can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5990then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5991
5992You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5993floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5994For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5995inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5996
5997@smallexample
5998#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5999@end smallexample
6000@end defmac
6001
6002@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6003A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6004comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
6005@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
6006machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
6007instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6008freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
6009like:
6010
6011@smallexample
6012#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6013   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6014    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6015@end smallexample
6016@end defmac
6017
6018@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6019On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6020register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6021regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6022hard register is set to a common value.  Use this hook to enable a
6023small pass which optimizes such cases.  This hook should return true
6024to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6025arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6026When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6027integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6028@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6029
6030The default version of this hook returns false.
6031@end deftypefn
6032
6033@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6034On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6035@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6036validly done in more than one mode.  On such a system, define this
6037target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6038both comparisons may be validly done.  If there is no such mode,
6039return @code{VOIDmode}.
6040
6041The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6042same.  If they are, it returns that mode.  If they are different, it
6043returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6044@end deftypefn
6045
6046@node Cond Exec Macros
6047@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6048@findex conditional execution
6049@findex predication
6050
6051There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6052supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6053represent conditional branches.
6054
6055@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6056A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6057@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6058versa.  Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6059predicates that cannot be reversed safely.  There is no need to validate
6060that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6061If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6062
6063@smallexample
6064#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6065   (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6066@end smallexample
6067@end defmac
6068
6069@node Costs
6070@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6071@cindex costs of instructions
6072@cindex relative costs
6073@cindex speed of instructions
6074
6075These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6076on the target machine.
6077
6078@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6079A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6080register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
6081expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
6082value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6083that.
6084
6085It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6086same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6087registers if they are not general registers.
6088
6089If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6090hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6091classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6092constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6093allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6094if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6095
6096These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6097@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6098@end defmac
6099
6100@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6101This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6102from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes
6103are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6104A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6105that.
6106
6107It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6108same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6109registers if they are not general registers.
6110
6111If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6112hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6113classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6114constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6115allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6116if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6117
6118The default version of this function returns 2.
6119@end deftypefn
6120
6121@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6122A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6123register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6124is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
6125is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
6126registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6127should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6128
6129If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6130the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6131needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6132between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6133more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6134reflect the actual cost of the move.
6135
6136GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6137secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6138a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6139secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61404 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6141value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6142are the same as to this macro.
6143
6144These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6145@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6146@end defmac
6147
6148@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
6149This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6150between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6151if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6152This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6153If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6154registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6155
6156If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6157the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6158needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6159between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6160more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6161reflect the actual cost of the move.
6162
6163GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6164secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6165a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6166secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61674 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6168value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6169are the same as to this target hook.
6170@end deftypefn
6171
6172@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6173A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
6174the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6175@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6176for speed.  When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6177optimal for code size rather than performance.  @var{predictable_p} is
6178true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6179@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6180@end defmac
6181
6182Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6183but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6184ordinarily expect.
6185
6186@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6187Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6188than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6189faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6190require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6191between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6192
6193When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6194finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6195load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
6196faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6197may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6198other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6199@end defmac
6200
6201@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6202Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6203@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6204than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6205handler.
6206
6207When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6208@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6209moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6210Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6211cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6212
6213If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
6214this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6215@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6216@end defmac
6217
6218@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6219The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6220which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6221string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
6222make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6223
6224Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6225@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6226the number of such sequences.
6227
6228The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6229optimized for speed rather than size.
6230
6231If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6232@end defmac
6233
6234@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6235A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6236copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6237will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6238than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6239@end defmac
6240
6241@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6242A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6243a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6244@end defmac
6245
6246@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6247The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6248of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6249or a library call.  Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6250eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6251
6252The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6253optimized for speed rather than size.
6254
6255If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6256@end defmac
6257
6258@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6259A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6260to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6261will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6262than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6263@end defmac
6264
6265@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6266The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6267of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6268a block set insn or a library call.
6269Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6270eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6271
6272The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6273optimized for speed rather than size.
6274
6275If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6276@end defmac
6277
6278@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6279A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6280used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6281other mechanism will be used.  Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6282storing values other than constant zero.
6283Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6284than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6285@end defmac
6286
6287@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6288A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6289used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6290other mechanism will be used.  Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6291called with a constant source string.
6292Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6293than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6294@end defmac
6295
6296@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6297A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6298thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6299@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6300@end defmac
6301
6302@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6303A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6304thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6305@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6306@end defmac
6307
6308@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6309A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6310thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6311@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6312@end defmac
6313
6314@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6315A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6316thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6317@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6318@end defmac
6319
6320@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6321A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6322thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6323@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6324@end defmac
6325
6326@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6327A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6328thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6329@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6330@end defmac
6331
6332@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6333This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6334thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6335@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6336@end defmac
6337
6338@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6339This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6340thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6341@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6342@end defmac
6343
6344@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6345Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6346function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6347@end defmac
6348
6349@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6350Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6351@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal.  This macro defaults to true if
6352@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6353@end defmac
6354
6355@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6356This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6357
6358The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6359available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6360as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6361That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6362that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6363either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6364(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6365
6366@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6367obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6368
6369In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6370@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6371instructions.
6372
6373On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6374for the cost of the expression.  The hook should modify this value as
6375necessary.  Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6376for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6377operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6378
6379When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6380false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6381size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6382
6383The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6384processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6385@end deftypefn
6386
6387@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6388This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6389@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
6390the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6391
6392For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6393true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
6394instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
6395all addresses will have equal costs.
6396
6397In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6398the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6399cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6400
6401For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6402and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
6403is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6404references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
6405the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6406that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6407instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
6408specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6409
6410This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6411
6412On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6413cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6414@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6415be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6416@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect
6417should be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs
6418should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6419registers on machines with lots of registers.
6420@end deftypefn
6421
6422@node Scheduling
6423@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6424
6425The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6426adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
6427hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
6428them: try the first ones in this list first.
6429
6430@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6431This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6432issue at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.
6433Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6434an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6435constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6436hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6437This value must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need
6438it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6439@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6440@end deftypefn
6441
6442@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6443This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6444from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
6445still be issued in the current cycle.  The default is
6446@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6447@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6448You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6449than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6450@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6451debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6452@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the instruction that
6453was scheduled.
6454@end deftypefn
6455
6456@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6457This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6458relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6459dependence @var{link}.  It should return the new value.  The default
6460is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}.  This can be used for example
6461to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6462that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6463data-dependence.  If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6464description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6465output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6466times of the first and the second insns.  If these values are not
6467acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too.  See also
6468@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6469@end deftypefn
6470
6471@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6472This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6473@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Increase the priority to
6474execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6475later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6476scheduling priorities of insns.
6477@end deftypefn
6478
6479@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6480This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6481list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6482combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6483@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6484debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6485@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6486list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
6487a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
6488reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6489@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
6490is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
6491the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
6492can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
6493@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6494@end deftypefn
6495
6496@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6497Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
6498function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
6499is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6500@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6501return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
6502this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6503scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6504cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6505@end deftypefn
6506
6507@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6508This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6509chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6510correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain.  For
6511example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6512analysis of dependencies.  This hook can use backward and forward
6513dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6514calculated.
6515@end deftypefn
6516
6517@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6518This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6519instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
6520pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
6521is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6522@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6523region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
6524scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6525@end deftypefn
6526
6527@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6528This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6529instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
6530cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
6531is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6532to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6533@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6534@end deftypefn
6535
6536@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6537This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6538@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6539@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6540@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6541@end deftypefn
6542
6543@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6544This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6545@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6546@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6547@end deftypefn
6548
6549@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6550The hook returns an RTL insn.  The automaton state used in the
6551pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6552when the new simulated processor cycle starts.  Usage of the hook may
6553simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6554processors.  If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6555based pipeline description.  The default is not to change the state
6556when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6557@end deftypefn
6558
6559@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6560The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6561@end deftypefn
6562
6563@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6564The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6565to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6566simulated processor cycle finishes.
6567@end deftypefn
6568
6569@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6570The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6571used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6572@end deftypefn
6573
6574@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6575The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6576The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6577to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6578state on a single insn is not enough.
6579@end deftypefn
6580
6581@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6582The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6583The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6584to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6585state on a single insn is not enough.
6586@end deftypefn
6587
6588@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6589This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6590for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler.  Usually the scheduler
6591chooses the first insn from the queue.  If the hook returns a positive
6592value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6593@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6594subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6595maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle.  For the
6596@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6597packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn.  Of course, if the
6598rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6599
6600This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6601processors.  Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6602with 3 pipelines.  Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6603@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6604@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}.  The
6605processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6606@var{B}.  In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6607until the next cycle.  If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6608the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6609
6610Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6611pipeline hazard recognizer.  We try quickly and easy many insn
6612schedules to choose the best one.
6613
6614The default is no multipass scheduling.
6615@end deftypefn
6616
6617@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6618
6619This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6620considered for the multipass insn scheduling.  If the hook returns
6621zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6622be issued.
6623
6624The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6625@end deftypefn
6626
6627@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6628This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6629scheduling.
6630@end deftypefn
6631
6632@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6633This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6634@end deftypefn
6635
6636@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6637This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6638an instruction.
6639@end deftypefn
6640
6641@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6642This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6643round of multipass scheduling.
6644@end deftypefn
6645
6646@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6647This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6648@end deftypefn
6649
6650@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6651This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6652@end deftypefn
6653
6654@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
6655This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6656on cycle @var{clock}.  If the hook returns nonzero,
6657@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle.  Instead,
6658the processor cycle is advanced.  If *@var{sort_p}
6659is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6660start as usually.  @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6661verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6662@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6663processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6664and the current processor cycle.
6665@end deftypefn
6666
6667@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6668This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6669the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6670are involved in the dependence too close to one another.  The parameters
6671to this hook are as follows:  The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6672being evaluated.  The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6673dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6674parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6675The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6676insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6677and @code{false} otherwise.
6678
6679Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6680where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6681delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6682that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6683important.  In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6684closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance;  however,
6685not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6686@end deftypefn
6687
6688@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6689This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6690the instruction stream.  The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6691per instruction data structures.
6692@end deftypefn
6693
6694@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6695Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6696@end deftypefn
6697
6698@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6699Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6700It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6701beginning of the block.  Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6702@end deftypefn
6703
6704@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6705Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6706@end deftypefn
6707
6708@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6709Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6710@end deftypefn
6711
6712@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6713Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6714@end deftypefn
6715
6716@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6717This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6718speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6719The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6720version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6721pattern.  The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6722or @minus{}1, if it doesn't.  @var{request} describes the type of requested
6723speculation.  If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6724the generated speculative pattern.
6725@end deftypefn
6726
6727@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6728This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6729for @var{insn}.  It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6730instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6731@end deftypefn
6732
6733@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6734This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6735check instruction.  If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6736speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6737@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6738be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6739recovery code (a simple check).  If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6740a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6741@var{insn} should be generated.  In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6742@end deftypefn
6743
6744@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6745This hook is used as a workaround for
6746@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6747called on the first instruction of the ready list.  The hook is used to
6748discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6749being scheduled on the current cycle.  If the hook returns @code{false},
6750@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6751For non-speculative instructions,
6752the hook should always return @code{true}.  For example, in the ia64 backend
6753the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6754is nearly full.
6755@end deftypefn
6756
6757@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6758This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6759enabled/used.
6760The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6761The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6762@end deftypefn
6763
6764@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6765This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6766resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6767the machine and the resources required by each instruction.  The target
6768backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound.  A very simple lower
6769bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6770of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6771@end deftypefn
6772
6773@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6774This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6775is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6776@end deftypefn
6777
6778@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6779This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It performs the operation specified
6780in its second parameter.
6781@end deftypefn
6782
6783@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6784
6785@hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
6786
6787@node Sections
6788@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6789@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
6790@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
6791
6792An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6793data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6794section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6795section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6796section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
6797of sections.
6798
6799@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6800@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6801The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6802is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6803as described below.  The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6804initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6805They may however depend on command-line flags.
6806
6807@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6808use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6809to be string literals.
6810
6811Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6812section is selected.  If your assembler falls into this category, you
6813should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6814@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6815
6816You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6817@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6818in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}.  The same is true of
6819@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  If you do not
6820create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6821reuse @code{text_section}.
6822
6823All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6824if the target does not provide them.
6825
6826@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6827A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6828assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6829Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6830@end defmac
6831
6832@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6833If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6834frequently executed functions of the program.  If not defined, GCC will provide
6835a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6836@end defmac
6837
6838@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6839If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6840executed functions in the program.
6841@end defmac
6842
6843@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6844A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6845assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6846data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6847@end defmac
6848
6849@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6850If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6851containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6852initialized, writable small data.
6853@end defmac
6854
6855@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6856A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6857assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6858data.
6859@end defmac
6860
6861@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6862If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6863containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6864uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and
6865@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6866uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6867@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6868used.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6872If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6873containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6874uninitialized, writable small data.
6875@end defmac
6876
6877@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6878If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6879assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6880common data.  The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6881@end defmac
6882
6883@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6884If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6885containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section.  The
6886default is @code{'T'}.
6887@end defmac
6888
6889@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6890If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6891containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6892initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6893not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6894variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6895@end defmac
6896
6897@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6898If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6899containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6900finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6901not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6902variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6903@end defmac
6904
6905@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
6909defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
6910both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6911@end defmac
6912
6913@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6914If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6915containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6916part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
6917defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
6918both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6919@end defmac
6920
6921@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6922If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6923via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6924the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6925@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6926to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6927sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
6928ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6929registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6930constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6931@end defmac
6932
6933@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6934If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6935variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go.  This is useful
6936when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6937you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6938they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6939expects.  For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6940MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6941require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6942to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6943access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6944@end defmac
6945
6946@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6947If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6948arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
6949@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6950and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6951@end defmac
6952
6953@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6954Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6955tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6956section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
6957readonly data section is used.
6958
6959This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6960@end defmac
6961
6962@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6963Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6964@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6965of its own that you need to create.
6966
6967GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6968any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6969described below.
6970@end deftypefn
6971
6972@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6973Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6974selecting sections.  Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6975should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6976local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6977
6978The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6979is in effect, and 0 otherwise.  The hook is typically redefined
6980when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6981in read-only sections even in executables.
6982@end deftypefn
6983
6984@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6985Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed.  You can
6986assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6987some sort.  @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6988requires link-time relocations.  Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6989local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6990@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6991
6992The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6993variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6994
6995See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6996@end deftypefn
6997
6998@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6999Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7000for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7001
7002In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7003function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7004it is unlikely to be called.
7005@end defmac
7006
7007@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
7008Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7009and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7010As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7011the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7012
7013The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7014ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol.  For
7015example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7016Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7017@end deftypefn
7018
7019@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7020Return the readonly data section associated with
7021@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7022The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7023the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7024if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7025otherwise.
7026@end deftypefn
7027
7028@hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7029
7030@hook TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION
7031
7032@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7033Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7034should be placed.  You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7035constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7036case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  @var{align} is the constant alignment
7037in bits.
7038
7039The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7040constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7041else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7042@end deftypefn
7043
7044@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7045Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7046by target-independent code.  The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7047the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7048or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++).  The return value of the
7049hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7050your target system.  The default implementation of this hook just
7051returns the @var{id} provided.
7052@end deftypefn
7053
7054@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7055Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7056treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7057function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7058
7059The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7060@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7061an entry in the constant pool.  In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7062rtl in question.  Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7063in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7064
7065In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7066a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}.  Most decls
7067will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed.  Global
7068register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7069rtl.  (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7070leave it alone.)
7071
7072The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7073that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl.  It will
7074be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7075declarations.  Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7076declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7077@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7078
7079@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7080The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7081@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7082Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7083encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7084discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7085
7086The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7087in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7088@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.  Check whether the default does what you need
7089before overriding it.
7090@end deftypefn
7091
7092@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7093Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7094the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7095may have added.
7096@end deftypefn
7097
7098@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7099Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7100The default version of this hook always returns false.
7101@end deftypefn
7102
7103@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7104Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7105``small data'' into a separate section.  The default value is false.
7106@end deftypevr
7107
7108@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7109
7110@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7111Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7112rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7113or executable image).
7114
7115The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7116for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7117currently supported object file formats.
7118@end deftypefn
7119
7120@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7121Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7122The default value is false.
7123@end deftypevr
7124
7125
7126@node PIC
7127@section Position Independent Code
7128@cindex position independent code
7129@cindex PIC
7130
7131This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7132independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7133generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7134@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7135@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You
7136must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7137when the source operand contains a symbolic address.  You may also
7138need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7139relative addresses.
7140@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7141@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7142
7143@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7144The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7145data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
7146processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
7147is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7148pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
7149is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7150necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7151when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7152@end defmac
7153
7154@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7155A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7156@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  If not defined,
7157the default is zero.  Do not define
7158this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7159@end defmac
7160
7161@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7162A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7163operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7164You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7165check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7166check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
7167(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7168position independent code.
7169@end defmac
7170
7171@node Assembler Format
7172@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7173
7174This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7175to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7176instructions do.
7177
7178@menu
7179* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
7180* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7181* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
7182* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
7183* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
7184                         and termination routines.
7185* Macros for Initialization::
7186                         Specific macros that control the handling of
7187                         initialization and termination routines.
7188* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
7189* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
7190* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7191* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7192@end menu
7193
7194@node File Framework
7195@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7196@cindex assembler format
7197@cindex output of assembler code
7198
7199@c prevent bad page break with this line
7200This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7201
7202@findex default_file_start
7203@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7204Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7205find at the beginning of a file.  The default behavior is controlled
7206by two flags, documented below.  Unless your target's assembler is
7207quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7208@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook.  This
7209lets other target files rely on these variables.
7210@end deftypefn
7211
7212@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7213If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7214printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7215@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect.  (If that macro has been defined
7216to the empty string, this variable has no effect.)  With the normal
7217definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7218assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7219whitespace from its input.  This allows it to work a bit faster.
7220
7221The default is false.  You should not set it to true unless you have
7222verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7223comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7224@end deftypevr
7225
7226@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7227If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7228for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7229@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled).  Most ELF assemblers expect
7230this to be done.  The default is false.
7231@end deftypevr
7232
7233@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7234Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7235to find at the end of a file.  The default is to output nothing.
7236@end deftypefn
7237
7238@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7239Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7240special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7241the stack being executable.  If your system uses this convention, you
7242should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function.  If you
7243need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7244this function.
7245@end deftypefun
7246
7247@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7248Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7249to find at the start of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7250nothing.
7251@end deftypefn
7252
7253@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7254Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7255to find at the end of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7256nothing.
7257@end deftypefn
7258
7259@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7260Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7261unwind info and debug info at the end of a file.  Some targets emit
7262here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7263because they couldn't have unwind info then.  The default is to output
7264nothing.
7265@end deftypefn
7266
7267@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7268A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7269assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7270the end of the line.
7271@end defmac
7272
7273@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7274A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7275statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7276@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7277assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7278that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7279@end defmac
7280
7281@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7282A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7283statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7284@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7285time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7286@end defmac
7287
7288@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7289A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7290which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7291the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7292
7293This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7294for the file format in use is appropriate.
7295@end defmac
7296
7297@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7298
7299@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7300A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7301@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7302in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7303the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7304of the filename using this macro.
7305@end defmac
7306
7307@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7308A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7309@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
7310macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7311@end defmac
7312
7313@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7314Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
7315should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7316of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{decl}
7317is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7318this section is associated.
7319@end deftypefn
7320
7321@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7322Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7323Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7324functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7325at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7326@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7327(from static destructors).
7328Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7329@end deftypefn
7330
7331@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7332
7333@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7334This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7335It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7336@end deftypevr
7337
7338@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7339@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7340This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7341section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7342This is true on most ELF targets.
7343@end deftypevr
7344
7345@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7346Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7347based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7348declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
7349null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7350
7351The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7352read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
7353need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7354set via @code{__attribute__}.
7355@end deftypefn
7356
7357@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7358Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7359switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7360enabled.  The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7361It can take the following values:
7362
7363@table @gcctabopt
7364@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7365@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7366
7367@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7368@var{text} is an option which has been enabled.  This might be as a
7369direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7370default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7371command line switch.  For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7372various different individual optimization passes.
7373
7374@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7375@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7376ignored.  If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7377target hook that either recording is starting or ending.  The first
7378time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7379warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7380wind down.  This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7381necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7382perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7383switches.
7384
7385@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7386This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7387
7388@item  SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7389This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7390@end table
7391
7392The hook's return value must be zero.  Other return values may be
7393supported in the future.
7394
7395By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7396provided for ELF based targets.  Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7397it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7398section in the assembler output file.  The name of the new section is
7399provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7400hook.
7401@end deftypefn
7402
7403@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7404This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7405ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7406hook.
7407@end deftypevr
7408
7409@need 2000
7410@node Data Output
7411@subsection Output of Data
7412
7413
7414@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7415@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7416@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7417@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7418@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7419@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7420@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7421@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7422@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7423These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7424of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7425byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7426aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
7427@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7428
7429The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7430followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
7431the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7432@end deftypevr
7433
7434@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7435The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7436integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7437in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
7438function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7439object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7440split the object into smaller parts.
7441
7442The default implementation of this hook will use the
7443@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7444when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7445@end deftypefn
7446
7447@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7448A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7449can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7450the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7451@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7452
7453If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7454so that a standard error message is printed.  If it prints an error message
7455itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7456return @code{true}.
7457@end deftypefn
7458
7459@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7460A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7461instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7462bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7463@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7464
7465If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7466Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7467@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7468@end defmac
7469
7470@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7471A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7472@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7473is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7474@end defmac
7475
7476@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7477You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
7478expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7479pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7480GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
7481not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7482pool before the function.
7483@end defmac
7484
7485@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7486A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7487constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
7488the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
7489be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
7490is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7491immediately after this call.
7492
7493If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7494not be defined.
7495@end defmac
7496
7497@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7498A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7499constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
7500anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7501
7502The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7503assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7504output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7505@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7506@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7507alignment.
7508
7509The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7510the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
7511responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7512Here is how to do this:
7513
7514@smallexample
7515@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7516@end smallexample
7517
7518When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7519@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
7520entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7521
7522You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7523@end defmac
7524
7525@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7526A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7527pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7528function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7529obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7530constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7531
7532If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7533define this macro.
7534@end defmac
7535
7536@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7537Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7538used as a logical line separator by the assembler.  @var{STR} points
7539to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7540a line separator uses multiple characters.
7541
7542If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7543the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7544@end defmac
7545
7546@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7547These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7548assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
7549default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7550@end deftypevr
7551
7552These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7553of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7554
7555@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7556@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7557@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7558@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7559@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7560@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7561These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7562target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7563the variable @var{l}.  For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7564@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7565simple @code{long int}.  For the others, it should be an array of
7566@code{long int}.  The number of elements in this array is determined
7567by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7568it go in each @code{long int} array element.  Each array element holds
756932 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7570on the host machine.
7571
7572The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7573using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7574machine's memory.
7575@end defmac
7576
7577@node Uninitialized Data
7578@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7579
7580Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7581outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7582
7583@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7584A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7585@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7586@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
7587is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.  It is
7588possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7589other member than a zero-length array is defined.  In this case, the
7590backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7591byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7592equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7593the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7594an ordinary undefined external.
7595
7596Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7597output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7598assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7599
7600This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7601common global variables are output.
7602@end defmac
7603
7604@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7605Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7606separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
7607place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7608handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
7609as the number of bits.
7610@end defmac
7611
7612@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7613Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7614variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7615is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7616in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7617@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
7618the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7619@end defmac
7620
7621@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7622A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7623@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7624@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{alignment}
7625is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7626
7627Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7628@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
7629@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7630before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7631the name, and a newline.
7632
7633There are two ways of handling global BSS@.  One is to define this macro.
7634The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7635switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7636You do not need to do both.
7637
7638Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7639non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7640efficiently.  C++ is one example of this.  However, if the target does
7641not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7642common in order to save space in the object file.
7643@end defmac
7644
7645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7646A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7647@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7648@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
7649is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7650
7651Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7652output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7653assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7654
7655This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7656static variables are output.
7657@end defmac
7658
7659@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7660Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7661separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
7662place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7663handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
7664as the number of bits.
7665@end defmac
7666
7667@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7668Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7669variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7670is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7671in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7672@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
7673the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7674@end defmac
7675
7676@node Label Output
7677@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7678
7679@c prevent bad page break with this line
7680This is about outputting labels.
7681
7682@findex assemble_name
7683@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7684A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7685@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7686Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7687output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7688assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
7689definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7690@end defmac
7691
7692@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7693A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7694@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7695a function.
7696Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7697output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7698assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
7699definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7700
7701If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7702usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7703@end defmac
7704
7705@findex assemble_name_raw
7706@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7707Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7708to refer to a compiler-generated label.  The default definition uses
7709@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7710that it is more efficient.
7711@end defmac
7712
7713@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7714A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7715size of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
7716default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7717systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7718
7719Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7720of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7721for your system.  If you need your own custom definitions of those
7722macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7723define this macro.
7724@end defmac
7725
7726@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7727A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7728@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7729symbol @var{name} is @var{size}.  @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7730If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7731provided.
7732@end defmac
7733
7734@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7735A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7736@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7737the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7738address.
7739
7740If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7741provided.  The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7742@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7743the difference between this and another symbol.  If your assembler does
7744not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7745to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7746@end defmac
7747
7748@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7749A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7750type of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
7751default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7752systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7753
7754Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7755@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
7756custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7757types at all, do not define this macro.
7758@end defmac
7759
7760@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7761A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7762the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}.  On systems that use ELF, the
7763default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7764the default is not to define this macro.
7765
7766Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7767@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
7768custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7769types at all, do not define this macro.
7770@end defmac
7771
7772@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7773A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7774@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7775symbol @var{name} is @var{type}.  @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7776that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7777you should not count on this.
7778
7779If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7780definition of this macro is provided.
7781@end defmac
7782
7783@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7784A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7785@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7786function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
7787outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7788@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
7789@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7790
7791If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7792usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7793
7794You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7795of this macro.
7796@end defmac
7797
7798@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7799A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7800@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7801which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7802function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7803representing the function.
7804
7805If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7806
7807You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7808of this macro.
7809@end defmac
7810
7811@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7812A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7813@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7814initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
7815label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
7816@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7817
7818If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7819usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7820
7821You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7822@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7823@end defmac
7824
7825@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
7826A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7827for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined.  This
7828target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7829@code{assemble_label}).  The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7830and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes.  The @var{name}
7831will be an internal label.
7832
7833The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7834usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7835
7836You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7837@end deftypefn
7838
7839@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7840A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7841@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7842for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7843
7844If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7845nothing.
7846@end defmac
7847
7848@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7849A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7850once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7851chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7852initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7853something about the size of the object.
7854
7855If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7856nothing.
7857
7858You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7859@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7860@end defmac
7861
7862@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7863This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7864@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7865that is, available for reference from other files.
7866
7867The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7868@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7869@end deftypefn
7870
7871@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7872This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7873@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7874global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7875
7876The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7877@end deftypefn
7878
7879@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7880A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7881@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7882that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7883no other definition is available.  Use the expression
7884@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7885itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7886for making that name weak, and a newline.
7887
7888If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7889support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7890macro.
7891@end defmac
7892
7893@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7894Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7895@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7896or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7897should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7898defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7899@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7900to make @var{name} weak.
7901@end defmac
7902
7903@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7904Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7905symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics.  @code{decl} is the
7906declaration of @code{name}.
7907@end defmac
7908
7909@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7910A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7911supports weak symbols.
7912
7913If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7914definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7915is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7916@end defmac
7917
7918@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7919A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7920
7921If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7922definition.  The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}.  Define
7923this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7924flag such as @option{-melf}.
7925@end defmac
7926
7927@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7928A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7929public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7930be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
7931format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7932section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7933requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7934@end defmac
7935
7936@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7937A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7938semantics.
7939
7940If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7941definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7942definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
7943you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7944setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7945be emitted as one-only.
7946@end defmac
7947
7948@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7949This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7950commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7951hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7952@end deftypefn
7953
7954@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7955A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7956that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7957The default is @code{0}.
7958
7959Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7960if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7961will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7962symbol should not be weak.  Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7963thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7964(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7965with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7966
7967The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero.  Define this macro for
7968targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7969restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7970table of contents.
7971@end defmac
7972
7973@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7974A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7975@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7976symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7977not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7978declaration.
7979
7980This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7981The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7982@end defmac
7983
7984@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7985This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7986pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
7987library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7988@end deftypefn
7989
7990@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7991This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7992directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used.  The Darwin target uses the
7993.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7994@end deftypefn
7995
7996@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7997A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7998@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7999@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8000is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8001systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8002@end defmac
8003
8004@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
8005
8006@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8007A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8008@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8009will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
8010to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8011encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8012@end defmac
8013
8014@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8015A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8016result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.  If not defined,
8017@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8018This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8019specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8020when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8021being taken.
8022@end defmac
8023
8024@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8025A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8026name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8027
8028It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8029used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
8030will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8031
8032It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8033object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8034should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8035beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
8036convention your system uses, and follow it.
8037
8038The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8039@end deftypefn
8040
8041@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8042A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8043label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8044@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8045may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
8046systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8047bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8048bundles.
8049
8050If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8051used.
8052@end defmac
8053
8054@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8055A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8056is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8057
8058This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8059produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8060with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8061
8062If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8063output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
8064@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
8065string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8066to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
8067@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8068you should know what it does on your machine.)
8069@end defmac
8070
8071@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8072A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8073@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8074@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8075added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8076
8077The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8078produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8079@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8080assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8081macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8082internal static variables in different scopes.
8083
8084Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8085conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
8086or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8087between the name and the number will suffice.
8088
8089If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8090which is correct for most systems.
8091@end defmac
8092
8093@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8094A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8095which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8096
8097@findex SET_ASM_OP
8098If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8099correct for most systems.
8100@end defmac
8101
8102@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8103A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8104which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8105to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
8106be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8107the tree nodes are available.
8108
8109@findex SET_ASM_OP
8110If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8111correct for most systems.
8112@end defmac
8113
8114@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8115A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8116(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8117of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8118current compilation unit.  The default is to not defer output of defines.
8119This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8120@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8121@end defmac
8122
8123@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8124A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8125which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8126@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8127an undefined weak symbol.
8128
8129Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8130@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8131@end defmac
8132
8133@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8134Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8135Objective-C methods.
8136
8137The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8138class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
8139the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8140@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8141
8142These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8143the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
8144systems define other ways of computing names.
8145
8146@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8147buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8148@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
814950 characters extra.
8150
8151The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8152method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8153@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8154in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8155
8156On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8157macro to provide more human-readable names.
8158@end defmac
8159
8160@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8161A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8162@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8163Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets whose
8164linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8165@end defmac
8166
8167@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8168A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8169@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8170unresolved Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets
8171whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8172@end defmac
8173
8174@node Initialization
8175@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8176@cindex initialization routines
8177@cindex termination routines
8178@cindex constructors, output of
8179@cindex destructors, output of
8180
8181The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8182(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8183data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
8184to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8185@code{main} is called.
8186
8187Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8188@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8189terminates.
8190
8191To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8192must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8193be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
8194system, you need to specify how to do this.
8195
8196There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8197initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
8198Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8199
8200@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8201@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8202The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8203initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8204termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8205
8206Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82070, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8208the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8209pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8210pointer containing zero.
8211
8212Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8213@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8214time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8215list; destructors in forward order.
8216
8217The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8218formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
8219aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8220Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
8221object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8222the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
8223accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8224Termination functions are handled similarly.
8225
8226This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8227@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
8228support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8229constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8230and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8231
8232When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8233upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
8234support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8235parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
8236program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8237
8238@smallexample
8239ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8240@end smallexample
8241
8242The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8243section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
8244for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
8245files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8246are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8247
8248The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8249compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
8250fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8251to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
8252of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8253that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8254
8255To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8256macro properly.
8257
8258If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8259@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8260entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8261it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8262after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
8263in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8264
8265In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8266two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8267and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
8268@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8269entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8270and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8271code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8272the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8273placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8274a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8275@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
8276section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8277the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8278the initialization process.
8279
8280The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8281This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8282file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
8283this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8284termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
8285an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
8286pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8287the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8288initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
8289via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
8290@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8291
8292@ifinfo
8293The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8294customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8295@end ifinfo
8296
8297@node Macros for Initialization
8298@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8299
8300Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8301and termination functions:
8302
8303@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8304If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8305operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
8306defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
8307using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8308macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8309run the initialization functions.
8310@end defmac
8311
8312@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8313If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8314This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8315on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8316be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8317@end defmac
8318
8319@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8320If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8321the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8322@end defmac
8323
8324@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8325If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8326the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8327@end defmac
8328
8329@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8330If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8331automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
8332should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8333the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8334function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8335
8336This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8337shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8338exception tables embedded in the code.
8339@end defmac
8340
8341@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8342If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8343automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
8344should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8345the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8346function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8347@end defmac
8348
8349@defmac INVOKE__main
8350If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8351@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
8352where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8353useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8354@end defmac
8355
8356@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8357If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8358compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8359of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8360encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8361@end defmac
8362
8363@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8364This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8365collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8366It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8367@end deftypevr
8368
8369@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8370If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8371the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8372
8373Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8374no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
8375priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8376otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8377
8378If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8379be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8380target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8381is not defined.
8382@end deftypefn
8383
8384@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8385This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8386functions rather than initialization functions.
8387@end deftypefn
8388
8389If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8390generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8391
8392If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8393constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8394an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8395
8396On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8397@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8398
8399@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8400Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8401object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8402object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8403
8404This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8405part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8406@end defmac
8407
8408@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8409Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8410to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
8411@command{nm}.
8412@end defmac
8413
8414@defmac NM_FLAGS
8415@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8416constructors and destructors and LTO info.  By default, @option{-n} is
8417passed.  Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8418are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8419produces.
8420@end defmac
8421
8422If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8423dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8424these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8425termination functions in shared libraries:
8426
8427@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8428Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8429which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8430@end defmac
8431
8432@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8433Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8434of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
8435of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8436from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8437code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8438line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8439@end defmac
8440
8441@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8442Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8443library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}).  @command{collect2}
8444strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8445constructor and destructor names.  This define is only needed on targets
8446that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8447@end defmac
8448
8449@node Instruction Output
8450@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8451
8452@c prevent bad page break with this line
8453This describes assembler instruction output.
8454
8455@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8456A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8457registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
8458register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8459@end defmac
8460
8461@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8462If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8463and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
8464registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8465to registers using alternate names.
8466@end defmac
8467
8468@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8469If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8470name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8471machine registers the name overlaps.  This macro defines additional
8472names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8473declarations to refer to registers using alternate names.  Unlike
8474@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8475register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8476
8477This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8478@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8479register name.  For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8480VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8481``s0'' and ``s1''.
8482@end defmac
8483
8484@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8485Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8486requires different names for the machine instructions.
8487
8488The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8489assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
8490macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8491points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8492written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
8493opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8494increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8495so that it will not be output twice.
8496
8497In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8498name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8499that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8500care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
8501@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8502
8503@findex recog_data.operand
8504If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8505elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8506
8507If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8508in the usual way.
8509@end defmac
8510
8511@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8512If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8513assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8514they will be output differently.
8515
8516Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8517extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8518elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8519The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8520template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8521by changing the contents of the vector.
8522
8523This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8524file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8525can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8526as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
8527syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8528writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8529
8530If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8531@end defmac
8532
8533@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8534If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8535output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8536if necessary.
8537
8538Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8539extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8540elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8541The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8542template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8543by checking the contents of the vector.
8544@end deftypefn
8545
8546@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8547A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8548assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
8549RTL expression.
8550
8551@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8552of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
8553printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
8554the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8555operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8556@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8557@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8558
8559@findex reg_names
8560If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8561The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8562@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8563@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8564
8565When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8566(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8567with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8568@var{code}.
8569@end defmac
8570
8571@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8572A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8573punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
8574@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8575punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8576in this way.
8577@end defmac
8578
8579@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8580A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8581assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8582whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8583
8584@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8585On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8586section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the hook
8587@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8588@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler
8589Format}.
8590@end defmac
8591
8592@findex dbr_sequence_length
8593@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8594A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8595been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8596determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8597currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8598or whatever.
8599
8600Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8601reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8602explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8603@end defmac
8604
8605@findex final_sequence
8606Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8607prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8608(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8609found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8610processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8611being output.
8612
8613@findex asm_fprintf
8614@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8615@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8616@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8617@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8618If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8619@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8620@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8621support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8622files can define these macros differently.
8623@end defmac
8624
8625@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8626If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8627statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8628the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
8629printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8630statements.  Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8631generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8632specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8633The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8634string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8635upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8636@end defmac
8637
8638@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8639If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8640different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8641numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8642first variant.
8643
8644If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8645@smallexample
8646@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8647@end smallexample
8648@noindent
8649in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8650first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
8651@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8652@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
8653within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
8654alternatives within the braces than the value of
8655@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8656
8657If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8658@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8659operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8660
8661Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8662@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8663the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
8664@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8665if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8666opcodes or operand order.
8667@end defmac
8668
8669@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8670A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8671which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8672The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8673profiling.
8674@end defmac
8675
8676@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8677A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8678which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8679The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8680profiling.
8681@end defmac
8682
8683@node Dispatch Tables
8684@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8685
8686@c prevent bad page break with this line
8687This concerns dispatch tables.
8688
8689@cindex dispatch table
8690@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8691A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8692pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8693@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
8694definitions of these labels are output using
8695@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8696way here.  For example,
8697
8698@smallexample
8699fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8700         @var{value}, @var{rel})
8701@end smallexample
8702
8703You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8704dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
8705will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8706@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8707mode and flags can be read.
8708@end defmac
8709
8710@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8711This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8712in a dispatch table are absolute.
8713
8714The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8715@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8716a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8717definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8718For example,
8719
8720@smallexample
8721fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8722@end smallexample
8723@end defmac
8724
8725@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8726Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8727specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
8728@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8729jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8730@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8731
8732This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8733for the table.
8734
8735If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8736@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8737@end defmac
8738
8739@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8740Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8741jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8742after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
8743the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
8744@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8745of the preceding label.
8746
8747If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8748the jump-table.
8749@end defmac
8750
8751@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8752This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@.  It
8753should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8754should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8755function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8756The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8757exception table.  The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8758true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8759
8760The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8761@end deftypefn
8762
8763@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8764This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8765It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8766to be broken up according to function.
8767
8768The default is that no label is emitted.
8769@end deftypefn
8770
8771@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8772
8773@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8774This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8775given instruction.  This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8776returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8777@end deftypefn
8778
8779@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8780
8781@node Exception Region Output
8782@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8783
8784@c prevent bad page break with this line
8785
8786This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8787region.
8788
8789@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8790If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8791exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
8792provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8793@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8794
8795You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8796unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8797@end defmac
8798
8799@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8800If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8801data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
8802might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8803collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8804
8805Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8806also defined.
8807@end defmac
8808
8809@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8810Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8811information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8812runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8813and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8814@end defmac
8815
8816@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8817An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8818that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8819@end defmac
8820
8821@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8822Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8823information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8824Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8825@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8826or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8827@end defmac
8828
8829@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8830This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8831by the target.  If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8832should return @code{UI_TARGET}.  If the target is to use the
8833@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8834should return @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8835information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8836
8837A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8838This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code.  The
8839default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8840
8841Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant.  It should
8842not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8843@var{opts}.  In particular, the
8844setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8845macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8846depending on this setting.
8847
8848The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8849@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8850@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If
8851@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8852must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8853@end deftypefn
8854
8855@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8856This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8857tables even when exceptions are not used.  It must not be modified by
8858command-line option processing.
8859@end deftypevr
8860
8861@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8862Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8863should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8864instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8865@end defmac
8866
8867@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8868This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8869function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8870@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
8871alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8872minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
8873the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8874@end defmac
8875
8876@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8877Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8878end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8879Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8880true otherwise.
8881@end deftypevr
8882
8883@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8884Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8885represent where to find the register pieces.  Define this hook if the
8886register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8887locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8888register in Dwarf.  Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8889If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8890@end deftypefn
8891
8892@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8893If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8894multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8895sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8896It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8897filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8898@var{address} is the address of the table.
8899@end deftypefn
8900
8901@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8902This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8903the type_info object identified by @var{sym}.  It should return @code{true}
8904if the reference was output.  Returning @code{false} will cause the
8905reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8906@end deftypefn
8907
8908@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8909This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8910based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets.  This effects
8911the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8912running a cleanup.  The default is @code{false}.
8913@end deftypevr
8914
8915@node Alignment Output
8916@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8917
8918@c prevent bad page break with this line
8919This describes commands for alignment.
8920
8921@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8922The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8923a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8924
8925This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8926to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8927define the macro.
8928
8929Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8930to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8931@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8932selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8933@end defmac
8934
8935@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8936The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8937@code{JUMP_ALIGN}.  This works only if
8938@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8939@end deftypefn
8940
8941@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8942The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8943a @code{BARRIER}.
8944
8945This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8946to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8947define the macro.
8948@end defmac
8949
8950@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8951The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8952@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
8953@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8954@end deftypefn
8955
8956@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8957The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8958a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8959
8960This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8961to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
8962define the macro.
8963
8964Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8965to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8966@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8967selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8968@end defmac
8969
8970@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8971The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8972@var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8973defined.
8974@end deftypefn
8975
8976@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8977The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8978If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8979the maximum of the specified values is used.
8980
8981Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8982to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8983@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8984selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8985@end defmac
8986
8987@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8988The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8989to @var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8990is defined.
8991@end deftypefn
8992
8993@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8994A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8995instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8996Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
8997expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8998@end defmac
8999
9000@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9001Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9002text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9003This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9004produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9005section.
9006@end defmac
9007
9008@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9009A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9010command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9011@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9012@end defmac
9013
9014@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9015Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9016for padding, if necessary.
9017@end defmac
9018
9019@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9020A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9021command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9022@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9023satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9024a C expression of type @code{int}.
9025@end defmac
9026
9027@need 3000
9028@node Debugging Info
9029@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9030
9031@c prevent bad page break with this line
9032This describes how to specify debugging information.
9033
9034@menu
9035* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9036* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9037* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9038* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9039* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9040* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
9041@end menu
9042
9043@node All Debuggers
9044@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9045
9046@c prevent bad page break with this line
9047These macros affect all debugging formats.
9048
9049@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9050A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9051register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
9052of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
9053some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9054versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9055compiler and another for DBX@.
9056
9057If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9058used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9059consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9060Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9061expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9062
9063If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9064does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9065redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9066@end defmac
9067
9068@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9069A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9070variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
9071computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9072gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
9073that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9074for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9075@option{-g} options is used.
9076@end defmac
9077
9078@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9079A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9080having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
9081@var{offset}.
9082@end defmac
9083
9084@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9085A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9086produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
9087this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9088debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9089@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9090@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9091
9092When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9093value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9094exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9095value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9096defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9097
9098The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9099user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9100@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9101@end defmac
9102
9103@node DBX Options
9104@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9105
9106@c prevent bad page break with this line
9107These are specific options for DBX output.
9108
9109@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9110Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9111in response to the @option{-g} option.
9112@end defmac
9113
9114@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9115Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9116in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9120Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9121GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9122debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
9123macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9124if there is any occasion to.
9125@end defmac
9126
9127@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9128Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9129in the text section.
9130@end defmac
9131
9132@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9133A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9134use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9135If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
9136applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9137@end defmac
9138
9139@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9140A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9141use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9142value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
9143@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9144information format.
9145@end defmac
9146
9147@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9148A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9149use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9150name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
9151macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9152@end defmac
9153
9154@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9155Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9156@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
9157describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9158On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9159@end defmac
9160
9161@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9162A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9163continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9164exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
9165operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9166must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9167with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
9168defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9169@end defmac
9170
9171@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9172Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9173the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
9174a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9175constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
9176if backslash is correct for your system.
9177@end defmac
9178
9179@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9180Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9181outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9182variable.
9183@end defmac
9184
9185@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9186The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9187for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9188@end defmac
9189
9190@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9191The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9192for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
9193provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9194@end defmac
9195
9196@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9197The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9198for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
9199``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9200@end defmac
9201
9202@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9203The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9204passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9205do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
9206@end defmac
9207
9208@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9209Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9210arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
9211in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9212code.
9213@end defmac
9214
9215@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9216Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9217the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9218relative to the start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses
9219an absolute address.
9220@end defmac
9221
9222@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9223Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9224the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9225start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9226@end defmac
9227
9228@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9229Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9230@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
9231macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9232number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
9233generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9234number for a type number.
9235@end defmac
9236
9237@node DBX Hooks
9238@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9239
9240@c prevent bad page break with this line
9241These are hooks for DBX format.
9242
9243@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9244Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9245information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
9246argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9247@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9248@end defmac
9249
9250@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9251Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9252@end defmac
9253
9254@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9255Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9256output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9257@end defmac
9258
9259@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9260A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9261number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9262@var{stream}.  @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9263invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9264unique labels in the assembly output.
9265
9266This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9267if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9268@end defmac
9269
9270@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9271Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9272@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9273On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9274disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9275@end defmac
9276
9277@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9278Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9279extension construct.  On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9280feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9281@end defmac
9282
9283@node File Names and DBX
9284@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9285
9286@c prevent bad page break with this line
9287This describes file names in DBX format.
9288
9289@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9290A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9291@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9292file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9293This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9294
9295This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9296for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9297
9298It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9299text section.  You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9300to do so.  If you do this, you must also set the variable
9301@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9302@end defmac
9303
9304@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9305Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9306of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9307the beginning of the file.
9308@end defmac
9309
9310@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9311Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9312that this object file was compiled by GCC@.  The default is to emit
9313an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9314@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9315@end defmac
9316
9317@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9318A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9319compilation of the main source file @var{name}.  Output should be
9320written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9321
9322If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9323of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9324@end defmac
9325
9326@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9327Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9328@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9329the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9330whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9331@end defmac
9332
9333@need 2000
9334@node SDB and DWARF
9335@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9336
9337@c prevent bad page break with this line
9338Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9339
9340@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9341Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9342for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9343@end defmac
9344
9345@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9346Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9347debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9348
9349@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9350Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9351be emitted for each function.  Instead of an integer return the enum
9352value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9353@end deftypefn
9354
9355To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9356define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9357@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9358prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9359as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9360@end defmac
9361
9362@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9363Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9364Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9365(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9366exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9367how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9368@end defmac
9369
9370@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9371This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9372unwind information to the debugger.  Normally the hook will return
9373@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9374return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9375
9376A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9377is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9378
9379A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9380This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9381@end deftypefn
9382
9383@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9384Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9385line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
9386tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9387@end defmac
9388
9389@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9390
9391@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9392
9393@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9394
9395@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9396A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9397@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9398@end defmac
9399
9400@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9401A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9402between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9403slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9404@end defmac
9405
9406@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9407A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9408section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9409given @var{size}.  The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9410@end defmac
9411
9412@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9413A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9414reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9415@end defmac
9416
9417@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9418A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9419the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section.  This
9420is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9421is referenced by a function.
9422@end defmac
9423
9424@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9425If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9426reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9427@end deftypefn
9428
9429@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9430Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9431SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9432macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
9433not define them yourself.
9434@end defmac
9435
9436@defmac SDB_DELIM
9437Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9438SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
9439delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
9440a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9441required.
9442@end defmac
9443
9444@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9445Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9446union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
9447allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9448it.
9449@end defmac
9450
9451@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9452Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9453enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
9454assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9455@end defmac
9456
9457@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9458A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9459number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9460@var{stream}.  The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9461@end defmac
9462
9463@need 2000
9464@node VMS Debug
9465@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9466
9467@c prevent bad page break with this line
9468Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9469
9470@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9471Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9472in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
9473is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9474@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
9475behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9476@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9477@end defmac
9478
9479@node Floating Point
9480@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9481@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9482@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9483
9484While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9485there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
9486means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9487in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9488doing the compilation.
9489
9490Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9491range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9492the target machine's format.  Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9493safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9494the target's arithmetic.  To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9495emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9496target floating point formats are identical.
9497
9498The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9499use.  All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9500floating-point calculations must use these macros.  They may evaluate
9501their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9502
9503@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9504The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9505machine's format.  Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9506array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9507quantity.
9508@end defmac
9509
9510@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9511Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}.  If the target
9512floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9513@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9514@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9515@end deftypefn
9516
9517@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9518Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9519@end deftypefn
9520
9521@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9522Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9523@end deftypefn
9524
9525@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9526Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero.  If
9527@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9528@end deftypefn
9529
9530@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9531Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9532representation for mode @var{mode}.  This routine can handle both
9533decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9534defined by the C language for both.
9535@end deftypefn
9536
9537@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9538Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9539@end deftypefn
9540
9541@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9542Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9543@end deftypefn
9544
9545@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9546Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9547@end deftypefn
9548
9549@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9550Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9551@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9552variable).
9553
9554The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}.  Only the
9555following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9556@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9557
9558If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9559target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9560@code{abort}.  Callers should check for this situation first, using
9561@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}.  @xref{Storage Layout}.
9562@end deftypefn
9563
9564@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9565Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9566@end deftypefn
9567
9568@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9569Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9570@end deftypefn
9571
9572@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9573Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}.  The
9574return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9575appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9576precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9577@end deftypefn
9578
9579@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9580Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9581which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}.  If the value is not
9582integral, it is truncated.
9583@end deftypefn
9584
9585@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9586Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9587into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.  The
9588value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9589@end deftypefn
9590
9591@node Mode Switching
9592@section Mode Switching Instructions
9593@cindex mode switching
9594The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9595
9596@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9597Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9598switching in an optimizing compilation.
9599
9600For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9601floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9602the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9603operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
9604purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9605be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9606or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9607
9608You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9609which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9610return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9611If you define this macro, you also have to define
9612@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9613@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9614@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9615are optional.
9616@end defmac
9617
9618@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9619If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9620initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
9621N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9622of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9623The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9624zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9625entity in question.
9626In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9627represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
9628switch is needed / supplied.
9629@end defmac
9630
9631@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9632@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
9633@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9634return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9635@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9636be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9637@end defmac
9638
9639@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9640If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9641mode switching.  It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9642different from the incoming mode).
9643@end defmac
9644
9645@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9646If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9647mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9648@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry.  If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9649is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9650@end defmac
9651
9652@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9653If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9654mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9655@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit.  If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9656is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9657@end defmac
9658
9659@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9660This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96610 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9662lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9663for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9664(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9665@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9666@end defmac
9667
9668@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9669Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9670@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9671the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9672@end defmac
9673
9674@node Target Attributes
9675@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9676@cindex target attributes
9677@cindex machine attributes
9678@cindex attributes, target-specific
9679
9680Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9681These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9682be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9683
9684@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9685If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9686attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9687specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9688entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9689take.
9690@end deftypevr
9691
9692@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9693If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9694machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9695given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9696subjected to name lookup.  If this is not defined, the default is
9697false for all machine-specific attributes.
9698@end deftypefn
9699
9700@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9701If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9702@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9703and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9704generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9705supposed always to be compatible.
9706@end deftypefn
9707
9708@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9709If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9710the newly defined @var{type}.
9711@end deftypefn
9712
9713@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9714Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9715handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9716@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
9717that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
9718function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9719merging.
9720@end deftypefn
9721
9722@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9723Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9724handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9725@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9726@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
9727when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9728attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
9729call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9730
9731@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9732If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9733for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9734@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}.  The compiler
9735will then define a function called
9736@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9737the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  You can also
9738add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9739to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9740@samp{dllexport} attributes.  This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9741@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9742@end deftypefn
9743
9744@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9745
9746@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9747Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9748@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}.  By
9749default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9750@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  The current implementation
9751of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9752on this implementation detail.
9753@end defmac
9754
9755@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9756Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9757when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
9758wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9759the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9760created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9761for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9762shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9763the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9764attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9765needed.
9766@end deftypefn
9767
9768@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9769@cindex inlining
9770This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9771into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9772attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
9773target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9774@end deftypefn
9775
9776@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9777This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9778it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9779options for the current function that might be different than the
9780options specified on the command line.  The hook should return
9781@code{true} if the options are valid.
9782
9783The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9784the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9785@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9786@end deftypefn
9787
9788@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9789This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9790in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9791options.
9792@xref{Option file format}.
9793@end deftypefn
9794
9795@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9796This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9797information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9798function specific options.
9799@end deftypefn
9800
9801@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9802This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9803information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9804function specific options.
9805@end deftypefn
9806
9807@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
9808This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9809set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9810input stream.  The options should be the same as handled by the
9811@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9812@end deftypefn
9813
9814@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9815Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9816a particular target machine.  You can override the hook
9817@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this.  This hooks is called
9818once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9819
9820Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9821@option{-O}.  That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9822
9823If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9824changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9825@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9826@end deftypefn
9827
9828@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9829This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9830cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information.  By
9831default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9832specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9833@end deftypefn
9834
9835@node Emulated TLS
9836@section Emulating TLS
9837@cindex Emulated TLS
9838
9839For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9840specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9841used.  A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9842configured for the requirements of a particular target.  For instance
9843the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9844layer.
9845
9846The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9847object.  To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9848which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9849address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9850
9851@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9852Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9853object to locate a TLS instance.  The default causes libgcc's
9854emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9855@end deftypevr
9856
9857@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9858Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9859program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9860initialized to zero.  If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9861have explicit initializers.  The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9862registration function to be used.
9863@end deftypevr
9864
9865@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9866Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9867be placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9868any section.
9869@end deftypevr
9870
9871@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9872Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9873placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9874section.
9875@end deftypevr
9876
9877@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9878Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9879The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9880@end deftypevr
9881
9882@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9883Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects.  The
9884default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9885@end deftypevr
9886
9887@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9888Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9889object type.  @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9890@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9891@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable.  The default creates a type suitable
9892for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9893@end deftypefn
9894
9895@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9896Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9897TLS control object.  @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9898is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9899initializer.  The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9900@end deftypefn
9901
9902@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9903Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9904fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9905single objects.  The default is false.
9906@end deftypevr
9907
9908@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9909Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9910may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9911@end deftypevr
9912
9913@node MIPS Coprocessors
9914@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9915@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9916
9917The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9918coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers.  GCC supports
9919accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9920and memory using asm-ized variables.  For example:
9921
9922@smallexample
9923  register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9924  unsigned int d;
9925
9926  d = cp0count + 3;
9927@end smallexample
9928
9929(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9930names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9931overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9932
9933Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9934be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9935later in the function.
9936
9937Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9938the FPU@.  One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9939floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9940
9941There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9942you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9943
9944@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9945A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9946alternate names of coprocessor registers.  The format of each entry should be
9947@smallexample
9948@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9949@end smallexample
9950Default: empty.
9951@end defmac
9952
9953@node PCH Target
9954@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9955@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9956
9957@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9958This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9959@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9960@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9961@end deftypefn
9962
9963@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9964This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9965compatible with the current settings.  It returns @code{NULL}
9966if so and a suitable error message if not.  Error messages will
9967be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9968
9969@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9970when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9971It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9972compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9973
9974The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9975suitable for most targets.
9976@end deftypefn
9977
9978@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9979If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9980@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9981of @code{target_flags}.  @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9982@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created.  The return
9983value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9984@end deftypefn
9985
9986@hook TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE
9987
9988@node C++ ABI
9989@section C++ ABI parameters
9990@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9991
9992@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9993Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9994These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects.  The
9995default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9996@end deftypefn
9997
9998@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9999This hook determines how guard variables are used.  It should return
10000@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used.  A return value of
10001@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10002@end deftypefn
10003
10004@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
10005This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10006whose elements have the indicated @var{type}.  Assumes that it is already
10007known that a cookie is needed.  The default is
10008@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10009IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10010@end deftypefn
10011
10012@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10013This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10014array cookies.  The default is to return @code{false}.
10015@end deftypefn
10016
10017@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10018If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10019class @var{type} to be overruled.  Upon entry @var{import_export}
10020will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10021to be imported and 0 otherwise.  This function should return the
10022modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10023backend's targeted operating system.
10024@end deftypefn
10025
10026@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10027This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10028the address of the object created/destroyed.  The default is to return
10029@code{false}.
10030@end deftypefn
10031
10032@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10033This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10034which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10035table to be emitted) may be an inline function.  Under the standard
10036Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10037the function is not declared inline in the class definition.  Under
10038some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10039method.  The default is to return @code{true}.
10040@end deftypefn
10041
10042@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10043
10044@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10045This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10046similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10047external linkage.  If this hook returns false, then class data for
10048classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10049unit will not be COMDAT.
10050@end deftypefn
10051
10052@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10053This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10054the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10055be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10056@end deftypefn
10057
10058@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10059This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10060should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10061is in effect.  The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10062@end deftypefn
10063
10064@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10065This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10066in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10067destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10068shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10069unloaded. The default is to return false.
10070@end deftypefn
10071
10072@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10073
10074@node Named Address Spaces
10075@section Adding support for named address spaces
10076@cindex named address spaces
10077
10078The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10079standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10080support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10081processors to specify alternate address spaces.  You can configure a
10082GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10083address spaces other than the default address space.  These address
10084spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10085@code{const} type attributes.
10086
10087Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10088pointers to the generic address space.
10089
10090For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10091to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10092processor.  Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10093issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10094local processor memory address space.  Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10095address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10096@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10097always 32 bits).
10098
10099Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10100range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10101address space.
10102
10103To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10104the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine.  For example,
10105the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10106named address space #1:
10107@smallexample
10108#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10109c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10110@end smallexample
10111
10112@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10113Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10114@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10115The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10116generic address space only.
10117@end deftypefn
10118
10119@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10120Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10121@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10122The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10123generic address space only.
10124@end deftypefn
10125
10126@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10127Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10128with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}.  This target
10129hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10130except that it includes explicit named address space support.  The default
10131version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10132@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10133target hooks for the given address space.
10134@end deftypefn
10135
10136@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10137Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10138@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  The @var{strict}
10139parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10140finished.  This target hook is the same as the
10141@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10142explicit named address space support.
10143@end deftypefn
10144
10145@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10146Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10147with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  This target
10148hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10149except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10150@end deftypefn
10151
10152@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10153Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10154contained within the @var{superset} named address space.  Pointers to
10155a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10156will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10157arithmetic operations.  Pointers to a superset address space can be
10158converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10159@end deftypefn
10160
10161@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10162Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10163@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10164space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10165to a different named address space.  When this hook it called, it is
10166guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10167as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10168@end deftypefn
10169
10170@node Misc
10171@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10172@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10173
10174@c prevent bad page break with this line
10175Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10176
10177@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10178Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10179has conditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10180conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10181blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10182set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10183to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10184@end defmac
10185
10186@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10187Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10188has unconditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10189conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10190blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10191set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10192to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10193@end defmac
10194
10195@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10196An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
10197elements of a jump-table should have.
10198@end defmac
10199
10200@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10201Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10202when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
10203it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10204To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10205make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10206The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10207flags can be updated.
10208@end defmac
10209
10210@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10211Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10212should contain relative addresses.  You need not define this macro if
10213jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10214contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10215is in effect.
10216@end defmac
10217
10218@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10219This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10220is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10221The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10222five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
10223@end deftypefn
10224
10225@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10226Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10227statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests.  This is
10228advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10229of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10230targets that would require a loop.  By default, this macro returns
10231@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10232@code{false} otherwise.
10233@end defmac
10234
10235@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10236Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10237smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10238Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10239@end defmac
10240
10241@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10242Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10243memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10244bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10245zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10246of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10247insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10248@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10249
10250This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10251greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10252value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
10253@code{UNKNOWN}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10254define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10255
10256You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10257the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10258of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10259when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10260integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10261
10262You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10263mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10264@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10265is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10266@end defmac
10267
10268@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10269Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10270extends.
10271@end defmac
10272
10273@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10274Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10275point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10276unsigned one.
10277@end defmac
10278
10279@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10280When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10281divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10282the reciprocal.  This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10283that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10284of mode @var{mode}.  The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10285has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10286@end deftypefn
10287
10288@defmac MOVE_MAX
10289The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10290between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10291@end defmac
10292
10293@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10294The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10295between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
10296is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
10297constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10298at run-time.
10299@end defmac
10300
10301@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10302A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10303actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10304of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
10305this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10306a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10307truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
10308instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10309include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10310also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10311arguments to bit-field instructions.
10312
10313If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10314position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10315instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10316
10317However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10318only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10319bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10320such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10321the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10322
10323You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10324@end defmac
10325
10326@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10327@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10328This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10329deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10330@xref{shift patterns}.
10331
10332On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10333shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10334equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}.  If
10335this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10336otherwise it should return 0.  A return value of 0 indicates that no
10337particular behavior is guaranteed.
10338
10339Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10340@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10341that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10342
10343The default implementation of this function returns
10344@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10345and 0 otherwise.  This definition is always safe, but if
10346@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10347nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10348by overriding it.
10349@end deftypefn
10350
10351@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10352A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10353``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10354bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10355operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10356
10357On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10358
10359@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
10360@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
10361When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10362modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10363If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10364such cases may improve things.
10365@end defmac
10366
10367@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10368The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10369are always extended to a wider integral mode.  Return
10370@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10371sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}.  Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10372otherwise.  (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10373representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10374@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10375@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}.  Also no target extends
10376@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10377widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10378
10379Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10380value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10381as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10382@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10383
10384Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10385describe two related properties.  If you define
10386@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10387to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10388extension.
10389
10390In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10391@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10392@code{mode}.
10393@end deftypefn
10394
10395@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10396A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10397with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10398(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true.  This description must
10399apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10400comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10401
10402A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10403comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10404and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
10405which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10406true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10407operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10408@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10409@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
10410the compiler.
10411
10412If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10413generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
10414replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10415the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10416For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10417@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10418@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10419expression
10420
10421@smallexample
10422(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10423@end smallexample
10424
10425@noindent
10426can be converted to
10427
10428@smallexample
10429(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10430@end smallexample
10431
10432@noindent
10433where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10434tested into the sign bit.
10435
10436There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10437for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10438but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
10439are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10440perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10441comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10442
10443Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10444from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
10445choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10446to be used:
10447
10448@itemize @bullet
10449@item
10450Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10451@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
10452``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10453comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10454combine the normalization with other operations.
10455
10456@item
10457For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10458slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10459other machines.
10460
10461@item
10462As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10463exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10464others.
10465
10466@item
10467Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10468@end itemize
10469
10470Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10471@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10472instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10473those cases, e.g., one matching
10474
10475@smallexample
10476(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10477@end smallexample
10478
10479Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10480condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10481@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
10482machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
10483and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10484@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
10485@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10486find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10487
10488If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used.  You need
10489not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10490instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10491@end defmac
10492
10493@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10494A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10495returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10496Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10497floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
10498this macro.
10499@end defmac
10500
10501@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10502A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10503for vector comparisons.  The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10504mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode.  Define
10505this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10506return a vector result.  If there are no such operations, do not define
10507this macro.  Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10508@code{constm1_rtx}.  This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10509the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10510given mode.
10511@end defmac
10512
10513@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10514@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10515A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10516for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10517A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10518If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10519evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10520entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10521the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10522In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10523this value.
10524
10525If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10526@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10527
10528This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10529relies on a particular value to get correct results.  Otherwise it
10530is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10531to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10532
10533Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10534and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10535visible to the user.  Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10536to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10537breaking the API@.
10538@end defmac
10539
10540@defmac Pmode
10541An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
10542this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10543pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10544On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10545modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10546
10547The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10548@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10549@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10550to @code{Pmode}.
10551@end defmac
10552
10553@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10554An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10555being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most CISC machines,
10556where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10557@code{QImode}.  On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10558size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10559as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10560@end defmac
10561
10562@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10563In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10564constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
10565hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10566where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10567strict conformance to the C Standard.
10568
10569Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10570convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10571files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10572@end defmac
10573
10574@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10575Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10576This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10577C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10578@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10579@end defmac
10580
10581@findex #pragma
10582@findex pragma
10583@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10584Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10585If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10586@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10587for each pragma.  The macro may also do any
10588setup required for the pragmas.
10589
10590The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10591other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
10592definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10593
10594If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10595defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10596
10597Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
10598@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10599silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10600@end defmac
10601
10602@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10603@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10604
10605Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10606@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma.  The
10607@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10608pragma of the form
10609
10610@smallexample
10611#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10612@end smallexample
10613
10614@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10615@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
10616routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10617on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
10618@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
10619callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
10620a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.  Macro expansion occurs on the
10621arguments of pragmas registered with
10622@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10623pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10624
10625Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10626compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10627other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10628to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10629building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
10630variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10631target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
10632the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10633code that uses @code{pragma_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
10634rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10635how to build this object file.
10636@end deftypefun
10637
10638@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10639Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10640arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10641@end defmac
10642
10643@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10644
10645@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10646If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10647the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10648This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10649@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10650@end defmac
10651
10652@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10653Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10654identifier names for the C family of languages.  0 means @samp{$} is
10655not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.  1 is the default;
10656there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10657@end defmac
10658
10659@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10660Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10661@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
10662G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
10663@samp{.} is used instead.
10664@end defmac
10665
10666@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10667Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10668@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
10669have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
10670are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10671@end defmac
10672
10673@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10674Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10675delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10676even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10677@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10678every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
10679or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10680you should define this macro.
10681
10682You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10683@end defmac
10684
10685@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10686Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10687delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10688even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10689@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
10690some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10691are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10692define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10693instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10694slot of @var{insn}.
10695
10696You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10697@end defmac
10698
10699@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10700Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10701global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10702symbols in another translation unit without user intervention.  For
10703instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10704from shared libraries (DLLs).
10705
10706You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10707@end defmac
10708
10709@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10710This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10711any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10712It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10713clobber.  The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10714corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10715clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm.  You can use
10716@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10717for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10718@end deftypefn
10719
10720@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10721Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10722in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10723@samp{""} if the target does not have a
10724separate math library.
10725
10726You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10727@end defmac
10728
10729@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10730Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10731specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10732
10733You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10734is wrong.
10735@end defmac
10736
10737@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10738Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10739functions, access, mkdir and  file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10740Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10741to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10742if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10743for cross-profiling.
10744@end defmac
10745
10746@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10747
10748A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10749conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
10750@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107511 if it does use cc0.
10752@end defmac
10753
10754@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10755Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10756conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10757@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10758contains information about the currently processed blocks.  @var{true_expr}
10759and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10760then-block and the else-block, respectively.  Set either @var{true_expr} or
10761@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10762@end defmac
10763
10764@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10765Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10766if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10767@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10768being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10769@end defmac
10770
10771@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10772A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10773be converted to conditional execution format.  @var{ce_info} points to
10774a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10775about the currently processed blocks.
10776@end defmac
10777
10778@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10779A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10780converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
10781can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10782to by @var{ce_info}.
10783@end defmac
10784
10785@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10786A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10787converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
10788can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10789to by @var{ce_info}.
10790@end defmac
10791
10792@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10793A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10794structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10795@end defmac
10796
10797@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10798If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10799added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure.  These should be initialized
10800by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10801@end defmac
10802
10803@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10804If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10805instruction stream.  The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10806just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10807
10808The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target.  Some use
10809it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10810laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10811Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10812
10813You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do.  The default
10814definition is null.
10815@end deftypefn
10816
10817@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10818Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10819that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
10820necessary setup.
10821
10822Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10823instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10824they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10825instructions or prefetch instructions).
10826
10827To create a built-in function, call the function
10828@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10829which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
10830up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10831only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10832@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10833@end deftypefn
10834
10835@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10836Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10837that need to be defined.  It should be a function that returns the
10838builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10839If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10840if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10841If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10842@code{error_mark_node}.
10843@end deftypefn
10844
10845@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10846
10847Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10848@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
10849function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10850convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10851@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10852@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10853ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
10854built-in function.
10855@end deftypefn
10856
10857@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
10858Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10859was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  This is done
10860@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10861implement a crude form of function overloading.  @var{fndecl} is the
10862declaration of the built-in function.  @var{arglist} is the list of
10863arguments passed to the built-in function.  The result is a
10864complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10865another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10866@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10867@end deftypefn
10868
10869@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
10870Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10871@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10872built-in function.  @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10873the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10874The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10875call's result.  If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10876@end deftypefn
10877
10878@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10879
10880Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10881low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10882could not be applied.
10883
10884Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10885instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10886the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10887By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10888loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10889@end deftypefn
10890
10891@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10892
10893Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10894Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10895@var{branch2} is possible.
10896
10897On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
10898filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10899may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10900@end defmac
10901
10902@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10903This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10904Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10905PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@.  @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10906of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10907@end deftypefn
10908
10909@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10910
10911When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10912register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10913to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10914it has been saved into can be used.  @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10915is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10916that had its initial value copied by using
10917@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10918Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10919to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10920the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10921@code{MEM}.
10922If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10923it might decide to use another register anyways.
10924You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10925that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10926register in question will not be clobbered.
10927The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10928allocation.
10929@end deftypefn
10930
10931@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10932This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10933@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap.  Targets can use
10934this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10935@code{unspec_volatile} operations.  You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10936to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10937passed along.
10938@end deftypefn
10939
10940@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10941The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10942context (@code{cfun}).  You can define this function if
10943the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10944per-function basis.  For example, it may be used to implement function
10945attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10946The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10947and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10948and is returning to processing at the top level.
10949The default hook function does nothing.
10950
10951GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10952some parts of the back end.  The hook function is not invoked in this
10953situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10954or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10955@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10956outside of any function scope.
10957@end deftypefn
10958
10959@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10960Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10961files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10962use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10963@end defmac
10964
10965@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10966Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10967automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
10968do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10969executable files.
10970@end defmac
10971
10972@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10973If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10974specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10975Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10976object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10977lists.
10978@end defmac
10979
10980@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10981Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10982method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10983must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10984For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10985the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10986defined as this expression:
10987
10988@smallexample
10989build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10990                              build_tree_list
10991                              (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10992                               NULL))
10993@end smallexample
10994@end defmac
10995
10996@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10997This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10998instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
10999every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11000reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11001
11002@smallexample
11003static bool
11004cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11005@{
11006  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11007@}
11008@end smallexample
11009@end deftypefn
11010
11011@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11012This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11013optimizations should be applied.  All registers in this class should be
11014usable interchangeably.  After reload, registers in this class will be
11015re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11016to inter-block scheduling.
11017@end deftypefn
11018
11019@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11020Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11021registers
11022that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11023returns true, they will be included.  The target code must than make sure
11024that all target registers in the class returned by
11025@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11026saved.  @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11027epilogues have already been generated.  Note, even if you only return
11028true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11029to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11030to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11031@end deftypefn
11032
11033@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11034This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11035This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11036modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11037@end deftypefn
11038
11039@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11040This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11041should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11042the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11043the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11044is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11045number of memory accesses.
11046@end deftypefn
11047
11048@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11049If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11050that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11051that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11052constant inline.  When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11053more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11054system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11055The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11056@end defmac
11057
11058@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11059This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11060target.  The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11061are present.  The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11062The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11063@end deftypefn
11064
11065@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11066This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11067target before any standard headers.  The parameter @var{stdinc}
11068indicates if normal include files are present.  The parameter
11069@var{sysroot} is the system root directory.  The parameter
11070@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11071@end deftypefn
11072
11073@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11074This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11075The parameter @var{path} is the include to register.  On Darwin
11076systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11077that are different from @option{-I}.
11078@end deftypefn
11079
11080@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11081This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11082for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11083@code{false} otherwise.  By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11084functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11085@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11086@end defmac
11087
11088@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11089If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11090target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11091option.  The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11092@end defmac
11093
11094@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11095If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11096@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11097@end defmac
11098
11099@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11100If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11101target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11102default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11103@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11104@end defmac
11105
11106@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11107If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11108@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11109@end defmac
11110
11111@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11112If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11113routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11114and scanf formatter settings.
11115@end defmac
11116
11117@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11118If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11119guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11120main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11121important, an explicit memory barrier must be used.  This is true of
11122many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11123``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11124and ia64.  The default is @code{false}.
11125@end deftypevr
11126
11127@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11128If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11129illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11130with prototype @var{typelist}.
11131@end deftypefn
11132
11133@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11134If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11135invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11136if validity should be determined by the front end.
11137@end deftypefn
11138
11139@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11140If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11141invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11142@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11143if validity should be determined by the front end.
11144@end deftypefn
11145
11146@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11147If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11148invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11149and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11150the front end.
11151@end deftypefn
11152
11153@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11154If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11155invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11156or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11157the front end.  This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11158@end deftypefn
11159
11160@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11161If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11162invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11163or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11164the front end.  This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11165@end deftypefn
11166
11167@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11168If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11169@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11170analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11171front end's normal promotion rules.  This hook is useful when there are
11172target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11173This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11174@end deftypefn
11175
11176@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11177If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11178@var{type}.  It should return the converted expression,
11179or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11180This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11181conversion rules.
11182This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11183@end deftypefn
11184
11185@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11186This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11187classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11188SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11189@end defmac
11190
11191@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11192This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11193NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11194@end defmac
11195
11196@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11197Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11198to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11199call stack unwinding.  It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11200and the associated definitions of those functions.
11201@end defmac
11202
11203@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11204Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11205necessary.
11206@end deftypefn
11207
11208@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11209This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11210different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11211argument list due to stack realignment.  Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11212is needed.
11213@end deftypefn
11214
11215@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11216When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11217arguments should be allocated to stack slots.  Normally, GCC allocates
11218stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11219debugging easier.  However, when a function is declared with
11220@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11221cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11222to the stack.  Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11223false for naked functions.  The default implementation always returns true.
11224@end deftypefn
11225
11226@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11227On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11228a constant.  If there is another constant already in a register that
11229is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11230is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11231subtraction.  We accomplish this through CSE.  Besides the value of
11232the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11233available expressions.  These are then queried when encountering new
11234constants.  The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11235down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11236@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11237accepted by immediate-add plus one.  We currently assume that the
11238value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2.  For example, on
11239MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11240@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}.  The default value
11241is zero, which disables this optimization.  @end deftypevr
11242
11243@hook TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11244